2891f3519c99a62c19cadc9d643e3490cd4a9c2b
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 cmsis_dap, ft232r.
2375 The following adapters have their own command to specify the serial string:
2376 ftdi, hla, jlink, kitprog, presto, st-link, vsllink, xds110.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379 @section Interface Drivers
2380
2381 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2382 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2383 available at run time.
2384
2385 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2386 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2387 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2388 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2389
2390 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2391 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2392 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2393 @end deffn
2394
2395 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2396 Displays status of RTCK option.
2397 Optionally sets that option first.
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2402 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2403 This has one driver-specific command:
2404
2405 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2406 Logs some status
2407 @end deffn
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2411 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2412 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2413 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2414 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2415 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2419 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2420 or v2 (USB bulk).
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2423 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2424 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2425 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2426 @example
2427 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2428 @end example
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2432 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2433
2434 @itemize @minus
2435 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2436 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2437 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2438 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2439 @end itemize
2440 @end deffn
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2443 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2444 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2445 interface string or for user class interface.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2449 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2450 @end deffn
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2454 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2458 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2462 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2463 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2464
2465 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2466 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2467
2468 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2469 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2470
2471 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2472 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2473 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2474 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2475 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2476 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2477
2478 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2479 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2480 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2481 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2482 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2483
2484 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2485 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2486 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2487 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2488
2489 @itemize @minus
2490 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2491 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2493 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2494 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2495 switching data and direction as necessary
2496 @end itemize
2497
2498 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2499 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2502 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2503 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2504 @example
2505 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2506 @end example
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2510 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2511 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2512 during device selection.
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi serial} serial-number
2516 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2517 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2518 is connected to the host.
2519 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2520 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2521 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2522 @end deffn
2523
2524 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2525 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2526 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2530 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2531 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2532 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2533 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2534 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2535 and initially asserted reset signals.
2536 @end deffn
2537
2538 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2539 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2540 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2541 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2542 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2543 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2544 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2545 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2546 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2547 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2548 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2549
2550 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2551 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2552 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2553 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2554 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2555 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2556
2557 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2558 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2559 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2560 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2561 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2562 are always driven by the FTDI.
2563
2564 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2565 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2566 @var{name}.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2570 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2571 @itemize @minus
2572 @item @option{0}, drive low
2573 @item @option{1}, drive high
2574 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2575 @end itemize
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2579 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2583 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2584
2585 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2586 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2587 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2588 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2589 @itemize @minus
2590 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2591 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2592 @end itemize
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2596 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2597
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2601 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2602 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2603 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2604
2605 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2606 @itemize @minus
2607 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2608 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2609 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2610 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2611 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2612 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2613 @end itemize
2614
2615 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2616 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2617 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2618 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2619 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2620 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2621 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2622 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2623
2624 FT232R
2625 @itemize @minus
2626 @item bit 7 - RI
2627 @item bit 6 - DCD
2628 @item bit 5 - DSR
2629 @item bit 4 - DTR
2630 @item bit 3 - CTS
2631 @item bit 2 - RTS
2632 @item bit 1 - RXD
2633 @item bit 0 - TXD
2634 @end itemize
2635
2636 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2637 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2638
2639 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2640 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2641 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2645 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2646 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2650 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2651 @end deffn
2652
2653 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2654 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2655 @end deffn
2656
2657 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2658 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2662 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2663 @end deffn
2664
2665 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2666 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2667 @end deffn
2668
2669 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2670 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2671 @end deffn
2672
2673 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2674 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2675 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2676 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2677 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2678 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2679 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2680 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2681 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2682 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2683 @end deffn
2684
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2688 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2689 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2690 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2691
2692 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2693 processors which are being simulated.
2694
2695 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2696 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2697 sockets instead of TCP.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2701 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2702 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2706 something like:
2707
2708 @example
2709 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2710 remote_bitbang port 3335
2711 remote_bitbang host foobar
2712 @end example
2713
2714 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2715 named mysocket:
2716
2717 @example
2718 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2719 remote_bitbang port 0
2720 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2721 @end example
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2725 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2726 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2727 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2728
2729 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2730 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2731 default values are used.
2732 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2733 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2734 @example
2735 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2736 @end example
2737 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2738 @example
2739 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2740 @end example
2741 @end deffn
2742
2743 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2744 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2745 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2746 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2747 target board.
2748
2749 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2750 @example
2751 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2752 reset_config srst_only
2753 @end example
2754 @end deffn
2755
2756 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2757 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2758 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2759 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2760 @end deffn
2761
2762 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2763 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2764 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2765 @end deffn
2766
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2770 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2771 This has one driver-specific command:
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2774 Display either the address of the I/O port
2775 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2776 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2777 This is a write-once setting.
2778 @end deffn
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2782 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2783 transports.
2784
2785 @quotation Compatibility Note
2786 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2787 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2788 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2789 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2790 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2791 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2792 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2793 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2794 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2795 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2796 @end quotation
2797
2798 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2799 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2800 states.
2801 @end deffn
2802 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2803 Display free device internal memory.
2804 @end deffn
2805 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2806 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2807 command version.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2810 Display the device configuration.
2811 @end deffn
2812 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2813 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2814 power state.
2815 @end deffn
2816 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2817 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2820 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2821 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2822 IP configuration.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2825 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2826 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2829 Reset the current configuration.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2832 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2835 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2836 pairs.
2837
2838 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2839 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2840 @example
2841 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2842 @end example
2843 @end deffn
2844 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2845 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2846 pairs.
2847
2848 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2849 @example
2850 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2851 77a90000
2852 @end example
2853 @end deffn
2854 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2855 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2856 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2857 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2858 the serial number instead, if possible.
2859
2860 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2861 @end deffn
2862 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2863 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2864 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2865
2866 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @end deffn
2869
2870 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2871 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2872 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2873 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2874 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2875 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2876 configuration script.
2877
2878 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2879 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2880 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2881 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2882 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2883
2884 Known limitations:
2885 @itemize @bullet
2886 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2887 and 2.7 MHz.
2888 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2889 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2890 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2891 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2892 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2893 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2894 communications with the target.
2895 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2896 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2897 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2898 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2899 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2900 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2901 @end itemize
2902
2903 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2904 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2905 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2906 @end deffn
2907
2908 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2909 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2910 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2911 @end deffn
2912
2913 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2914 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2915 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2916 target as a side-effect.
2917 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2921 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2922 version, and target voltage.
2923 @end deffn
2924 @end deffn
2925
2926 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2927 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2928 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2929 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2930 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2931
2932 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2933 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2934 This is a write-once setting.
2935 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2936
2937 @itemize @minus
2938 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2939 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2940 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2941 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2942 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2943 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2944 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2945 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2946 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2947 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2948 some versions of
2949 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2950 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2951 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2952 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2953 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2954 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2955 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2956 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2957 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2958 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2959 @end itemize
2960 @end deffn
2961
2962 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2963 Display either the address of the I/O port
2964 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2965 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2966 This is a write-once setting.
2967
2968 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2969 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2970 you may encounter a problem.
2971 @end deffn
2972
2973 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2974 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2975 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2976 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2977 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2978 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2979
2980 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2981 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2982 @quotation Tip
2983 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2984 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2985 @example
2986 > parport toggling_time 1000
2987 > adapter speed 500
2988 @end example
2989 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2990 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2991 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2992 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2993 large set of samples.
2994 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2995 @example
2996 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2997 @end example
2998 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2999 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3000
3001 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3002 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3003 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3004 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3005 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3006 be conservative.
3007 @end quotation
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3011 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3012 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3013 @end deffn
3014
3015 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3016 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3017
3018 @example
3019 adapter driver parport
3020 parport port 0x278
3021 parport cable wiggler
3022 @end example
3023 @end deffn
3024
3025 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3026 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3027 @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
3028 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3029 @end deffn
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3033 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3034 @end deffn
3035
3036 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3037 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3041 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3042
3043 @quotation Note
3044 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3045 which are not currently documented here.
3046 @end quotation
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @anchor{hla_interface}
3050 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3051 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3052 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3053 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3054
3055 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3056 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3057 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3058 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3059 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3060 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3061
3062 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3063 Currently Not Supported.
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3067 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3071 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3072 @end deffn
3073
3074 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3075 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3076 @end deffn
3077
3078 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3079 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3080 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3081
3082 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3083 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3084 ST-LINK server software module}.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3088 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3089 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3090 @end deffn
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3094 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3095 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3096 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3097 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3098
3099 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3100 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3101 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3102 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3103
3104 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3105 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3106
3107 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3108 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3109 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3110
3111 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3112 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3113 ST-LINK server software module}.
3114
3115 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3116 @end deffn
3117
3118 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3119 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3123 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3127 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3128 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3129
3130 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3131 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3132 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3133 the target's supply voltage.
3134 @example
3135 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3136 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3137 @end example
3138 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3139 @example
3140 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3141 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3142 3.24891518738
3143 @end example
3144 @end deffn
3145 @end deffn
3146
3147 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3148 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3149 @end deffn
3150
3151 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3152 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3153 @end deffn
3154
3155 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3156 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3157 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3158 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3159 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3160
3161 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3162 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3163 XDS110 found will be used.
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3167 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3168 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3169 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3170 @end deffn
3171
3172 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3173 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3174 version).
3175 @end deffn
3176 @end deffn
3177
3178 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3179 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3180 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3181 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3182 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3183
3184 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3185
3186 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3187 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3188
3189 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3190 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3191
3192 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3193
3194 @end deffn
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3198 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3199 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3200
3201 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3202 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3203 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3204 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3205 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3206 configuration on exit.
3207
3208 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3209
3210 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3211 pinout.
3212
3213 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3214 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3215 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3216 individually.
3217 @end deffn
3218
3219 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3220 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3221 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3222 @end deffn
3223
3224 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3225 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3226 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3230 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3231 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3232 @end deffn
3233
3234 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3235 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3236 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3237 @end deffn
3238
3239 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3240 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3241 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3242 @end deffn
3243
3244 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3245 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3246 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3247 @end deffn
3248
3249 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3250 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3251 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3252 @end deffn
3253
3254 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3255 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3256 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3257 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3261 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3265 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3269 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3270 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3274 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3275 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3276 list can be found in the
3277 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3278 @end deffn
3279
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3283 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3284 of the one which is most popular.
3285
3286 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3287
3288 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3289 pinout.
3290
3291 @end deffn
3292
3293
3294 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3295 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3296 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3297
3298 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3299 @end deffn
3300
3301
3302 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3303 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3304 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3305
3306 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3307 @end deffn
3308
3309
3310 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3311 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3312 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3313
3314 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3315 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3316 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3317
3318 @itemize @minus
3319 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3320 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3321 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3322 @end itemize
3323 @end deffn
3324
3325 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3326 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3327 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3328 @end deffn
3329 @end deffn
3330
3331
3332 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3333 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3334 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3335 DPI server interface.
3336
3337 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3338 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3339 @end deffn
3340
3341 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3342 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3343 @end deffn
3344 @end deffn
3345
3346
3347 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3348
3349 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3350 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3351
3352 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3353 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3354
3355 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3356 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3357 @example
3358 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3359 @end example
3360 @end deffn
3361
3362 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3363 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3364 @example
3365 buspirate speed normal
3366 @end example
3367 @end deffn
3368
3369 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3370 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3371 @itemize @minus
3372 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3373 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3374 @end itemize
3375 For example:
3376 @example
3377 buspirate mode normal
3378 @end example
3379 @end deffn
3380
3381 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3382 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3383 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3384 For example:
3385 @example
3386 buspirate pullup 0
3387 @end example
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3391 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3392 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3393 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3394 @example
3395 buspirate vreg 0
3396 @end example
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3400 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3401 @end deffn
3402 @example
3403 buspirate led 1
3404 @end example
3405
3406 @end deffn
3407
3408
3409 @section Transport Configuration
3410 @cindex Transport
3411 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3412 and the debug adapter you are using,
3413 several transports may be available to
3414 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3415 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3416 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3417 version of OpenOCD.
3418 @end deffn
3419
3420 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3421 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3422
3423 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3424 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3425 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3426 adapter's driver).
3427
3428 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3429 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3430 supported by the debug adapter.
3431
3432 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3433 transport, if any.
3434 @end deffn
3435
3436 @subsection JTAG Transport
3437 @cindex JTAG
3438 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3439 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3440 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3441 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3442 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3443 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3444
3445 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3446 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3447 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3448 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3449 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3450
3451 @subsection SWD Transport
3452 @cindex SWD
3453 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3454 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3455 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3456 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3457 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3458 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3459 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3460
3461 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3462 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3463 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3464 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3465 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3466
3467 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3468 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3469 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3470 expected to change.
3471 @end deffn
3472
3473 @subsection SPI Transport
3474 @cindex SPI
3475 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3476 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3477 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3478 solution for flash programming.
3479
3480 @anchor{swimtransport}
3481 @subsection SWIM Transport
3482 @cindex SWIM
3483 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3484 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3485 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3486 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3487
3488 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3489
3490 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3491
3492 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3493 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3494 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3495 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3496 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3497
3498 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3499 @section JTAG Speed
3500 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3501 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3502 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3503 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3504 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3505 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3506 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3507 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3508 power management software that may be active.
3509
3510 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3511 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3512 target event handler.
3513 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3514 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3515 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3516 sets up those clocks).
3517 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3518 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3519 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3520 in the target config file.
3521 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3522 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3523 config file instead.
3524 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3525 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3526 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3527
3528 @example
3529 jtag_rclk 3000
3530 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3531 @end example
3532
3533 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3534 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3535 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3536 may not be the fastest solution.
3537
3538 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3539 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3540 which support adaptive clocking.
3541
3542 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3543 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3544 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3545 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3546 than the speed specified.
3547
3548 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3549 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3550 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3551 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3552
3553 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3554 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3555 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3556 JTAG clocking after setup.
3557 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3558 If the interface device can not
3559 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3560 @end deffn
3561
3562 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3563 @cindex adaptive clocking
3564 @cindex RTCK
3565 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3566 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3567 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3568 @example
3569 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3570 jtag_rclk 3000
3571 @end example
3572 @end defun
3573
3574 @node Reset Configuration
3575 @chapter Reset Configuration
3576 @cindex Reset Configuration
3577
3578 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3579 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3580 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3581 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3582 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3583 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3584 Please see the various board files for examples.
3585
3586 @quotation Note
3587 To maintainers and integrators:
3588 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3589 Normally the board configuration file
3590 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3591 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3592
3593 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3594 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3595 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3596 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3597 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3598 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3599 @end quotation
3600
3601 @section Types of Reset
3602
3603 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3604 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3605 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3606
3607 @itemize @bullet
3608 @item
3609 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3610 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3611 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3612 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3613 @item
3614 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3615 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3616 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3617 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3618 @item
3619 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3620 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3621 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3622 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3623 @item
3624 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3625 several other types of reset.
3626 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3627 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3628 There may be individual module resets.
3629 @end itemize
3630
3631 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3632 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3633 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3634 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3635 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3636 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3637 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3638 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3639 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3640
3641 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3642 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3643
3644 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3645 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3646 common issues are:
3647
3648 @itemize @bullet
3649
3650 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3651 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3652 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3653 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3654 when either of those signals is not connected.
3655 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3656 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3657 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3658 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3659
3660 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3661 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3662 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3663 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3664
3665 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3666 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3667 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3668 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3669 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3670 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3671 hardware debouncing.
3672 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3673 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3674
3675 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3676 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3677 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3678 to use push/pull output drivers.
3679 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3680 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3681 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3682 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3683
3684 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3685 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3686 issues (not limited to errata).
3687 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3688 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3689 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3690 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3691 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3692 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3693 @end itemize
3694
3695 There can also be other issues.
3696 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3697 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3698 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3699 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3700 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3701 Agreement (NDA).
3702
3703 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3704 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3705 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3706
3707 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3708 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3709
3710 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3711
3712 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3713 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3714 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3715 allowing it to be deasserted.
3716 @end deffn
3717
3718 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3719 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3720 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3721 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3722 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3723 @end deffn
3724
3725 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3726 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3727 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3728 allowing it to be deasserted.
3729 @end deffn
3730
3731 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3732 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3733 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3734 @end deffn
3735
3736 @anchor{reset_config}
3737 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3738 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3739 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3740 configuration scripts.
3741
3742 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3743 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3744 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3745 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3746 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3747 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3748 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3749 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3750
3751 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3752 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3753 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3754 -- may be specified at a time.
3755 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3756 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3757 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3758 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3759 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3760
3761 @itemize
3762 @item
3763 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3764 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3765 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3766 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3767 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3768
3769 @quotation Tip
3770 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3771 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3772 @end quotation
3773
3774 @item
3775 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3776 signal implementations.
3777 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3778 indicating everything behaves normally.
3779 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3780 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3781 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3782 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3783 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3784 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3785 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3786
3787 @item
3788 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3789 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3790 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3791 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3792 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3793 while SRST is asserted.
3794 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3795 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3796
3797 @item
3798 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3799 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3800 is required to use this option.
3801 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3802 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3803 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3804 be asserted before any target connection.
3805 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3806 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3807 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3808 @end itemize
3809
3810 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3811 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3812 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3813 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3814 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3815
3816 @itemize
3817 @item
3818 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3819 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3820 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3821 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3822
3823 @item
3824 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3825 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3826 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3827 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3828 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3829 @end itemize
3830 @end deffn
3831
3832 @section Custom Reset Handling
3833 @cindex events
3834
3835 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3836 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3837 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3838 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3839 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3840 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3841
3842 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3843 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3844 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3845 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3846 want to reset everything at once.
3847
3848 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3849 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3850 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3851 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3852 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3853 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3854 needs special attention.
3855
3856 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3857 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3858 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3859 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3860 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3861 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3862 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3863 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3864 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3865
3866 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3867 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3868 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3869 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3870 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3871
3872 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3873 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3874 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3875 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3876 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3877 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3878 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3879 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3880 or potentially some other value.
3881
3882 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3883 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3884 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3885 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3886 (or their associated targets)
3887 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3888
3889 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3890 they return.
3891 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3892 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3893 @end deffn
3894
3895 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3896 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3897 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3898 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3899 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3900 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3901 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3902 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3903 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3904 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3905 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3906 @end deffn
3907
3908 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3909 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3910 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3911 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3912 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3913 @end deffn
3914
3915
3916 @node TAP Declaration
3917 @chapter TAP Declaration
3918 @cindex TAP declaration
3919 @cindex TAP configuration
3920
3921 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3922 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3923
3924 @itemize @bullet
3925 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3926 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3927 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3928 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3929 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3930 start running that code.
3931 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3932 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3933 and missing connections.
3934 @end itemize
3935
3936 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3937 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3938 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3939 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3940 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3941
3942 @section Scan Chains
3943 @cindex scan chain
3944
3945 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3946 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3947 They also need to be added to
3948 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3949 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3950 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3951 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3952 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3953 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3954 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3955 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3956
3957 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3958 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3959 command, presented in the next chapter.
3960 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3961 debugging targets.)
3962 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3963
3964 @verbatim
3965 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3966 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3967 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3968 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3969 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3970 @end verbatim
3971
3972 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3973 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3974 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3975 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3976 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3977 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3978 until they are told to do so.
3979
3980 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3981 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3982 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3983 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3984
3985 @example
3986 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3987 @end example
3988
3989 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3990 by a given chip.
3991 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3992 and so forth.
3993 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3994 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3995 both inside a single chip and between them.
3996 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3997
3998 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3999 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4000 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4001 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4002 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4003 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4004 includes commands something like this:
4005
4006 @example
4007 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4008 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4009 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4010 @end example
4011
4012 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4013 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4014 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4015
4016 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4017 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4018 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4019 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4020 @example
4021 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4022 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4023 @}
4024 @end example
4025 @end deffn
4026
4027 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4028 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4029 and their status.
4030 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4031 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4032 but systems with a JTAG router can
4033 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4034 @end deffn
4035
4036 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4037 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4038
4039 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4040 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4041
4042 @section TAP Names
4043 @cindex dotted name
4044
4045 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4046 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4047 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4048 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4049 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4050 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4051 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4052 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4053
4054 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4055 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4056 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4057
4058 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4059
4060 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4061 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4062 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4063
4064 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4065 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4066 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4067 overridable.
4068
4069 @cindex TAP naming convention
4070 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4071 and should follow this convention:
4072
4073 @itemize @bullet
4074 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4075 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4076 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4077 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4078 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4079 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4080 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4081 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4082 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4083 with a single TAP;
4084 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4085 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4086 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4087 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4088 @end itemize
4089
4090 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4091
4092 @itemize @bullet
4093 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4094 @*The length in bits of the
4095 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4096 @end itemize
4097
4098 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4099
4100 @itemize @bullet
4101 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4102 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4103 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4104 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4105 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4106 (the TAP is linked in).
4107 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4108 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4109 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4110 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4111 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4112 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4113 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4114 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4115 values that were found but not included in the list.
4116
4117 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4118 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4119 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4120 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4121 hardware to find these values.
4122 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4123 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4124 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4125 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4126 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4127 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4128 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4129 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4130 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4131 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4132 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4133 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4134 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4135 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4136 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4137 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4138 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4139 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4140 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4141 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4142 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4143 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4144 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4145 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4146 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4147 @end itemize
4148 @end deffn
4149
4150 @section Other TAP commands
4151
4152 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4153 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4154 @end deffn
4155
4156 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4157 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4158 At this writing this TAP attribute
4159 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4160 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4161 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4162 See the next section for information about the available events.
4163
4164 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4165 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4166 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4167 @end deffn
4168
4169 @section TAP Events
4170 @cindex events
4171 @cindex TAP events
4172
4173 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4174 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4175 The other applies to debugger targets,
4176 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4177
4178 The TAP events currently defined are:
4179
4180 @itemize @bullet
4181 @item @b{post-reset}
4182 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4183 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4184 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4185 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4186 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4187
4188 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4189 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4190 of any particular target.
4191 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4192 @item @b{setup}
4193 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4194 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4195 @item @b{tap-disable}
4196 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4197 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4198 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4199 @item @b{tap-enable}
4200 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4201 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4202 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4203 @end itemize
4204
4205 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4206 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4207 contents to be accurate), you might:
4208
4209 @example
4210 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4211 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4212 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4213 @}
4214 @end example
4215
4216
4217 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4218 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4219 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4220 @cindex jrc
4221
4222 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4223 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4224 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4225 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4226 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4227
4228 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4229 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4230 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4231 be visible.
4232 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4233 ignores, such as:
4234
4235 @itemize
4236 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4237 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4238 TAPs receive new instructions.
4239 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4240 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4241 @end itemize
4242
4243 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4244 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4245 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4246 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4247
4248 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4249 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4250
4251 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4252 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4253 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4254 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4255 should define TAP event handlers using
4256 code that looks something like this:
4257
4258 @example
4259 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4260 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4261 @}
4262 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4263 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4264 @}
4265 @end example
4266
4267 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4268
4269 @example
4270 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4271 @end example
4272
4273 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4274 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4275 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4276 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4277
4278 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4279 If necessary, disables the tap
4280 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4281 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4282 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4283 and "0" if it is disabled.
4284 @end deffn
4285
4286 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4287 If necessary, enables the tap
4288 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4289 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4290 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4291 and "0" if it is disabled.
4292 @end deffn
4293
4294 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4295 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4296 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4297 and "0" if it is disabled.
4298
4299 @quotation Note
4300 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4301 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4302 @end quotation
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @anchor{autoprobing}
4306 @section Autoprobing
4307 @cindex autoprobe
4308 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4309
4310 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4311 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4312 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4313 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4314
4315 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4316 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4317 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4318 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4319 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4320 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4321 right when they come out of reset).
4322
4323 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4324
4325 @example
4326 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4327 reset_config trst_and_srst
4328 jtag_rclk 8
4329 @end example
4330
4331 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4332 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4333
4334 @enumerate
4335 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4336 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4337 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4338 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4339 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4340 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4341 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4342 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4343 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4344 that is discovered.
4345 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4346 register, it will report it.
4347 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4348 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4349 @end enumerate
4350
4351 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4352 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4353 that's a bit more complex:
4354
4355 @example
4356 clock speed 8 kHz
4357 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4358 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4359 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4360 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4361 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4362 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4363 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4364 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4365 @end example
4366
4367 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4368 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4369 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4370 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4371 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4372 and so forth.
4373
4374 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4375 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4376 @cindex DAP declaration
4377
4378 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4379 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4380 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4381 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4382 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4383
4384 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4385
4386 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4387 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4388 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4389 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4390 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4391
4392 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4393
4394 @itemize @bullet
4395 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4396 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4397 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4398 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4399 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4400
4401 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4402 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4403 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4404 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4405 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4406 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4407
4408 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4409 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4410 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4411 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4412 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4413 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4414 @end itemize
4415 @end deffn
4416
4417 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4418 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4419 for TCL scripting.
4420 @end deffn
4421
4422 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4423 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4424 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4425 @end deffn
4426
4427 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4428 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4429 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4430 initialization, too.
4431 @end deffn
4432
4433 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4434
4435 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4436 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4437 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4438 @end deffn
4439
4440 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4441 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4442 @end deffn
4443
4444 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4445 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4446 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4447 or set a new value @var{value}.
4448 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4449 @end deffn
4450
4451 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4452 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4453 @end deffn
4454
4455 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4456 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4457 value @var{value}.
4458
4459 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4460 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4461 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4462
4463 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4464 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4465 @end deffn
4466
4467 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4468 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4469 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4470 @end deffn
4471
4472 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4473 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4474 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4475 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4476 @end deffn
4477
4478 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4479 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4480
4481 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4482 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4483 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4484 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4485 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4486 for details.
4487
4488 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4489 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4490 the pattern:
4491 @example
4492 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4493 @end example
4494
4495 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4496 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4497 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4498 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4499 @example
4500 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4501 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4502 @end example
4503
4504 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4505 @example
4506 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4507 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4508 @end example
4509
4510 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4511 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4512
4513 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4514 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4515 example with a proper dap name:
4516 @example
4517 xxx.dap apcsw default
4518 @end example
4519 @end deffn
4520
4521 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4522 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4523 Disabled by default
4524 @end deffn
4525
4526
4527 @node CPU Configuration
4528 @chapter CPU Configuration
4529 @cindex GDB target
4530
4531 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4532 You can also access these targets without GDB
4533 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4534 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4535 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4536 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4537
4538 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4539 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4540
4541 @section Target List
4542 @cindex target, current
4543 @cindex target, list
4544
4545 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4546 where each member has a name.
4547 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4548 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4549 (plural!) command.
4550 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4551 look like with more than one:
4552 @verbatim
4553 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4554 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4555 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4556 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4557 @end verbatim
4558
4559 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4560 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4561 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4562 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4563 space seen by that current target.
4564 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4565 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4566 are examples; and there are many more.
4567
4568 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4569
4570 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4571 Returns the name of the current target.
4572 @end deffn
4573
4574 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4575 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4576 @example
4577 foreach t [target names] @{
4578 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4579 @}
4580 @end example
4581 @end deffn
4582
4583 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4584 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4585
4586 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4587 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4588 command names are singular.}
4589
4590 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4591 targets in a user friendly form.
4592
4593 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4594 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4595 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 @section Target CPU Types
4599 @cindex target type
4600 @cindex CPU type
4601
4602 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4603 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4604 when calling @command{target create}.
4605 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4606 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4607 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4608 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4609 what core-specific commands may be available
4610 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4611 and more.
4612
4613 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4614 since there's a command to list them.
4615
4616 @anchor{targettypes}
4617 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4618 Lists all supported target types.
4619 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4620
4621 @itemize @bullet
4622 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4623 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4624 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4625 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4626 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4627 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4628 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4629 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4630 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4631 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4632 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4633 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4634 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4635 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4636 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4637 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4638 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4639 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4640 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4641 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4642 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4643 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4644 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4645 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4646 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4647 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4648 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4649 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4650 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4651 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4652 support for new CPUs.
4653 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4654 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4655 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4656 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4657 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4658 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4659 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4660 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4661 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4662 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4663 @itemize @minus
4664 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4665 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4666 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4667 @end itemize
4668 And two debug interfaces cores:
4669 @itemize @minus
4670 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4671 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4672 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4673 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4674 @end itemize
4675 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4676 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4677 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4678 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4679 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4680 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4681 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4682 @end itemize
4683 @end deffn
4684
4685 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4686 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4687 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4688 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4689 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4690 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4691 reflect design generations;
4692 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4693 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4694
4695 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4696 @section Target Configuration
4697
4698 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4699 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4700 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4701 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4702 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4703
4704 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4705 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4706 optional parts.
4707 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4708 command, created as part of target creation.
4709
4710 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4711 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4712 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4713 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4714 to be much more board-specific.
4715 The key steps you use might look something like this
4716
4717 @example
4718 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4719 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4720 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4721 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4722 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4723 @end example
4724
4725 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4726 on-chip SRAM.
4727 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4728 writes to target memory;
4729 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4730 GDB memory checksumming;
4731 and more.
4732
4733 @quotation Warning
4734 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4735 inaccessible when application code
4736 (such as an operating system)
4737 enables or disables the MMU.
4738 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4739 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4740 easy access to other addresses needed.
4741 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4742 @end quotation
4743
4744 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4745 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4746 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4747 controllers.
4748 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4749 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4750 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4751
4752 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4753 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4754 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4755 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4756 purposes including additional configuration.
4757
4758 @itemize @bullet
4759 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4760 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4761 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4762 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4763
4764 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4765 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4766 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4767 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4768 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4769 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4770 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4771
4772 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4773 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4774 @end itemize
4775 @end deffn
4776
4777 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4778 The options accepted by this command may also be
4779 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4780 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4781 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4782
4783 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4784 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4785 and changing its endianness.
4786
4787 @itemize @bullet
4788
4789 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4790 used to access this target.
4791
4792 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4793 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4794 create and manage DAP instances.
4795
4796 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4797 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4798
4799 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4800 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4801 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4802 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4803 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4804 same event name assigns only one handler.
4805
4806 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4807 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4808
4809 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4810 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4811 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4812 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4813 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4814 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4815 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4816
4817 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4818 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4819 or virtual address is being used.
4820
4821 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4822 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4823
4824 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4825 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4826 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4827 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4828 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4829
4830 @anchor{rtostype}
4831 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4832 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4833 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4834 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4835 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4836 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4837
4838 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4839 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4840 access the target for debugging.
4841
4842 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4843 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4844 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4845 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4846
4847 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4848 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4849 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4850 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4851 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4852
4853 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4854 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4855 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4856 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4857 command @command{gdb_port}.
4858 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4859
4860 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4861 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4862 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4863 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4864 @end itemize
4865 @end deffn
4866
4867 @section Other $target_name Commands
4868 @cindex object command
4869
4870 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4871 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4872
4873 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4874 Once a button is created a button
4875 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4876 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4877 configure it like this:
4878
4879 @example
4880 # Create
4881 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4882 # Modify
4883 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4884 # Query
4885 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4886 # Report
4887 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4888 @end example
4889
4890 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4891 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4892
4893 @example
4894 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4895 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4896 @end example
4897
4898 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4899
4900 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4901 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4902 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4903 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4904 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4905 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4906 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4907 They are not otherwise documented here.
4908 @end deffn
4909
4910 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4911 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4912 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4913 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4914 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4915 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4916 the target side uses raw memory.
4917
4918 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4919 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4920 The script orientation comes from working with data
4921 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4922 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4923 and neither store nor return those values.
4924
4925 @itemize
4926 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4927 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4928 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4929 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4930 @end itemize
4931 @end deffn
4932
4933 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4934 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4935 @command{$target_name configure}
4936 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4937 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4938 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4939 There are a few special cases:
4940
4941 @itemize @bullet
4942 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4943 event named @var{event_name}.
4944 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4945 two parameters.
4946 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4947 This is a special case because this is set using
4948 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4949 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4950 @end itemize
4951
4952 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4953 all the targets you might use something like this:
4954
4955 @example
4956 foreach name [target names] @{
4957 set y [$name cget -endian]
4958 set z [$name cget -type]
4959 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4960 $x $name $y $z]
4961 @}
4962 @end example
4963 @end deffn
4964
4965 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4966 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4967 Displays the current target state:
4968 @code{debug-running},
4969 @code{halted},
4970 @code{reset},
4971 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4972 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4973 @end deffn
4974
4975 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4976 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4977 currently associated with this target.
4978 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4979 @end deffn
4980
4981 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4982 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4983 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4984 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4985 @end deffn
4986
4987 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4988 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4989 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4990 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4991 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4992 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4993 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4994 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4995 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4996 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4997 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4998 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4999 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5000 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
5001 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
5002 @end deffn
5003
5004 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5005 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5006 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5007 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5008 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5009 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5010 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5011 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5012 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5013 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5014 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5015 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5016 @end deffn
5017
5018 @anchor{targetevents}
5019 @section Target Events
5020 @cindex target events
5021 @cindex events
5022 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5023 For example:
5024 @itemize @bullet
5025 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5026 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5027 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5028 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5029 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5030 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5031 to set up system clocks or
5032 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5033 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5034 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5035 @end itemize
5036
5037 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5038 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5039 @command{target create ... -event}.
5040
5041 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5042 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5043 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5044
5045 @example
5046 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5047 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5048 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5049 @}
5050 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5051 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5052 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5053 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5054 @}
5055 @end example
5056
5057 The following target events are defined:
5058
5059 @itemize @bullet
5060 @item @b{debug-halted}
5061 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5062 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5063 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5064 @item @b{early-halted}
5065 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5066 @item @b{examine-start}
5067 @* Before target examine is called.
5068 @item @b{examine-end}
5069 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5070 @item @b{examine-fail}
5071 @* After target examine fails.
5072 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5073 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5074 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5075 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5076 connect GDB to running target.
5077 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5078 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5079 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5080 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5081 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5082 is in RAM or read only memory.
5083 Default is @code{halt}
5084 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5085 @* When GDB disconnects
5086 @item @b{gdb-end}
5087 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5088 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5089 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5090 @code{reset init})
5091 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5092 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5093 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5094 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5095 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5096 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5097 @item @b{gdb-start}
5098 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5099 @item @b{halted}
5100 @* The target has halted
5101 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5102 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5103 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5104 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5105 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5106 @item @b{reset-assert}
5107 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5108 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5109 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5110 it instead of asserting SRST.
5111 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5112 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5113 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5114 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5115 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5116 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5117 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5118 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5119 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5120 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5121 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5122 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5123 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5124 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5125 released on the scan chain.
5126 @item @b{reset-end}
5127 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5128 @item @b{reset-init}
5129 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5130 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5131
5132 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5133 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5134 multiplexing, and so on.
5135 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5136 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5137 @item @b{reset-start}
5138 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5139 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5140
5141 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5142 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5143 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5144 @item @b{resume-start}
5145 @* Before any target is resumed
5146 @item @b{resume-end}
5147 @* After all targets have resumed
5148 @item @b{resumed}
5149 @* Target has resumed
5150 @item @b{step-start}
5151 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5152 @item @b{step-end}
5153 @* After single-step has completed
5154 @item @b{trace-config}
5155 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5156 @end itemize
5157
5158 @quotation Note
5159 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5160 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5161 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5162 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5163 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5164 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5165 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5166 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5167 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5168 check if the core has changed status.
5169 @end quotation
5170
5171 @node Flash Commands
5172 @chapter Flash Commands
5173
5174 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5175 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5176 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5177 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5178 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5179 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5180 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5181 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5182 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5183
5184 Flash Steps:
5185 @enumerate
5186 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5187 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5188 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5189 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5190 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5191 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5192 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5193 @item GDB Flashing
5194 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5195 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5196 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5197 @end enumerate
5198
5199 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5200 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5201 so that it can't boot.
5202 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5203 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5204
5205 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5206 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5207 @cindex flash configuration
5208
5209 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5210 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5211 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5212 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5213 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5214 see the driver-specific documentation.
5215
5216 @itemize @bullet
5217 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5218 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5219 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5220 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5221 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5222 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5223 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5224 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5225 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5226 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5227 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5228 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5229 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5230 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5231 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5232 commands to the flash controller.
5233 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5234 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5235 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5236 for more information.
5237 @end itemize
5238 @quotation Note
5239 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5240 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5241 @end quotation
5242 @end deffn
5243
5244 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5245 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5246 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5247 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5248 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5249 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5250 @end deffn
5251
5252 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5253 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5254 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5255 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5259 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5260 depends on the flash type.
5261 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5262 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5263 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5264 but most don't bother.
5265 @end deffn
5266
5267 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5268
5269 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5270 begins.
5271
5272 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5273 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5274 until the programming session is finished.
5275
5276 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5277 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5278
5279 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5280
5281 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5282 @cindex flash erasing
5283 @cindex flash reading
5284 @cindex flash writing
5285 @cindex flash programming
5286 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5287
5288 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5289 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5290 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5291 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5292 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5293
5294 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5295 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5296 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5297 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5298 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5299
5300 @quotation Note
5301 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5302 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5303 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5304 back to a flash bank.
5305 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5306 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5307 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5308 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5309 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5310 @end quotation
5311
5312 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5313 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5314 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5315 disabled first.
5316 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5317 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5318 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5319
5320 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5321 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5322 up to and including @var{last}.
5323 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5324 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5325 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5330 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5331 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5332 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5333 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5334 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5335 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5336 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5337 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5338 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5339 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5340 before erase starts.
5341 @end deffn
5342
5343 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5344 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5345 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5346 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5347 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5348 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5349 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5350 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5351 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5352 before issuing this command.
5353 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5354 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5355 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5356 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5357 @end deffn
5358 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5359
5360 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5361 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5362 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5363 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5364 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5365 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5366 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5367 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5368 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5369 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5370 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5374 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5375 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5376 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5377 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5378 @end deffn
5379
5380 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5381 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5382 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5383 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5384 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5385 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5386 @end deffn
5387
5388 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5389 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5390 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5391 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5392 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5393 @end deffn
5394
5395 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5396 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5397 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5398 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5399 to the base address for each section in the image.
5400 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5401 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5402 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5403 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5404 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5405 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5406 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5407 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5408 each image section.
5409
5410 @quotation Warning
5411 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5412 data you want to preserve.
5413 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5414 sections might be erased with no notice.
5415 @itemize
5416 @item
5417 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5418 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5419 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5420 @item
5421 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5422 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5423 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5424 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5425 @end itemize
5426 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5427 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5428 @end quotation
5429
5430 @end deffn
5431
5432 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5433 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5434 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5435 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5436 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5437 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5438 ordinary memory reads.
5439 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5440 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5441 check for successful programming.
5442 @end deffn
5443
5444 @section Other Flash commands
5445 @cindex flash protection
5446
5447 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5448 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5449 and display that status.
5450 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5454 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5455 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5456
5457 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5458 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5459 and possibly stale information.
5460 @end deffn
5461
5462 @anchor{flashprotect}
5463 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5464 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5465 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5466 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5467 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5468 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5469 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5470 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5471 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5472 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5473 @end deffn
5474
5475 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5476 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5477 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5478 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5479 @end deffn
5480
5481 @anchor{program}
5482 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5483 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5484 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5485 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5486 @end deffn
5487
5488 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5489 @section Flash Driver List
5490 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5491 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5492 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5493
5494 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5495 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5496 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5497
5498 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5499
5500 @itemize
5501 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5502 @end itemize
5503
5504 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5505 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5506 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5507 @example
5508 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5509 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5510 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5511 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5512 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5513 @end example
5514 @end deffn
5515
5516 @subsection External Flash
5517
5518 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5519 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5520 @cindex CFI
5521 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5522 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5523 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5524 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5525 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5526 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5527 configure a bus and its timings), or
5528 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5529 on the flash chip.
5530 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5531 speed up operation.
5532
5533 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5534
5535 @itemize
5536 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5537 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5538 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5539 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5540 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5541 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5542 @end itemize
5543
5544 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5545 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5546
5547 @example
5548 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5549 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5550 @end example
5551
5552 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5553 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5554 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5555
5556 @example
5557 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5558 @end example
5559
5560 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5561 @end deffn
5562
5563 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5564 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5565 @cindex SPI
5566 @cindex jtagspi
5567 @cindex bscan_spi
5568 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5569 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5570 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5571 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5572 accessed through JTAG.
5573
5574 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5575 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5576 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5577 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5578 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5579 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5580
5581 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5582 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5583 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5584 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5585 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5586 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5587 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5588 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5589
5590 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5591 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5592 command, see below.
5593
5594 @itemize
5595 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5596 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5597 @var{USER1} instruction.
5598 @end itemize
5599
5600 @example
5601 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5602 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5604 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5605 @end example
5606
5607 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5608 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5609 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5610 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5611 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5612 @example
5613 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5614 @end example
5615 @end deffn
5616
5617 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5618 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5619 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5620 @example
5621 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5622 @end example
5623 @end deffn
5624
5625 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5626 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5627 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5628 @end deffn
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5632 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5633 @cindex xcf
5634 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5635 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5636 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5637 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5638 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5639
5640 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5641 command accepts additional parameters:
5642 @itemize
5643 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5644 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5645 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5646 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5647 in master mode.
5648 @end itemize
5649 @example
5650 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5651 @end example
5652 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5653 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5654 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5655 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5656 dedicated sector.
5657 @end deffn
5658
5659 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5660 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5661 button.
5662 @example
5663 xcf configure 0
5664 @end example
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 Additional driver notes:
5668 @itemize
5669 @item Only single revision supported.
5670 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5671 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5672 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5673 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5674 @end itemize
5675 @end deffn
5676
5677 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5678 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5679 @cindex SPIFI
5680 @cindex lpcspifi
5681 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5682 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5683 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5684
5685 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5686 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5687 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5688 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5689 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5690
5691 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5692 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5693 are configured by the driver.
5694
5695 @example
5696 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5697 @end example
5698
5699 @end deffn
5700
5701 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5702 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5703 @cindex SMI
5704 @cindex stmsmi
5705 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5706 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5707 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5708 SPI flash devices.
5709 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5710 flash devices can be connected.
5711
5712 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5713 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5714 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5715 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5716 the flash content.
5717
5718 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5719 to identify the memory bank.
5720 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5721 flash size, are detected automatically.
5722
5723 @example
5724 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5725 @end example
5726
5727 @end deffn
5728
5729 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5730 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5731 @cindex QuadSPI
5732 @cindex OctoSPI
5733 @cindex stmqspi
5734 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5735 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5736 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5737 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5738 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5739 mode is not.
5740
5741 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5742 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5743 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5744 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5745
5746 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5747 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5748 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5749
5750 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5751 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5752 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5753 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5754 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5755 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5756
5757 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5758 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5759 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5760 should be avoided.
5761
5762 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5763 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5764 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5765 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5766 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5767 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5768
5769 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5770 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5771 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5772 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5773 persist across openocd invocations.
5774
5775 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5776 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5777 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5778 required (see 'set' command).
5779
5780 @example
5781 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5782 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5783 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5784 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5785 @end example
5786
5787 There are three specific commands
5788 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5789 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5790 chip specific write protection engaged.
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5794 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5795 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5796 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5797 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5798 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5799
5800 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5801 which don't support an id command.
5802
5803 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5804 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5805 @end deffn
5806
5807 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5808 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5809 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5810 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5811 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5812
5813 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5814 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5815 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5816 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5817
5818 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5819
5820 To check basic communication settings, issue
5821 @example
5822 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5823 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5824 @end example
5825 for single flash mode or
5826 @example
5827 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5828 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5829 @end example
5830 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5831
5832 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5833 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5834 need a dummy address, e.g.
5835 @example
5836 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5837 @end example
5838 should return the status register contents.
5839
5840 @end deffn
5841
5842 @end deffn
5843
5844 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5845 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5846 Microcontroller platform.
5847
5848 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5849 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5850
5851 @example
5852 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5853 @end example
5854
5855 @end deffn
5856
5857 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5858 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5859 @cindex ath79
5860 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5861 chip selects.
5862 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5863 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5864 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5865 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5866 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5867 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5868
5869 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5870 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5871 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5872 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5873 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5874 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5875 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5876 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5877 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5878 with the default CS0.
5879 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5880 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5881 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5882
5883 @example
5884 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5885
5886 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5887 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5888 # distinguish the banks.
5889 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5890 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5891 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5892 @end example
5893
5894 @end deffn
5895
5896 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5897 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5898 @cindex fespi
5899
5900 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5901
5902 @example
5903 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5904 @end example
5905 @end deffn
5906
5907 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5908
5909 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5910 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5911 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5912 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5913 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5914 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5915
5916 @example
5917 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5918 @end example
5919 @end deffn
5920
5921 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5922 @cindex ambiqmicro
5923 @cindex apollo
5924 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5925 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5926 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5927 with the target using SWD.
5928
5929 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5930 the device class of the MCU.
5931 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5932 to set up the flash banks.
5933 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5934 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5935
5936 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5937 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5938 and the second bank starts after the first.
5939
5940 @example
5941 # Flash bank 0
5942 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5943 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5944 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5945 $_TARGETNAME
5946 @end example
5947
5948 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5949 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5950 are available to the user.
5951
5952 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5953
5954 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5955 Erase entire bank.
5956 @end deffn
5957 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5958 Erase device pages.
5959 @end deffn
5960 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5961 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5962 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5963 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5964 the flash.
5965 @end deffn
5966 @end deffn
5967
5968 @anchor{at91samd}
5969 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5970 @cindex at91samd
5971 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5972 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5973
5974 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5975
5976 The devices have one flash bank:
5977
5978 @example
5979 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5980 @end example
5981
5982 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5983 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5984 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5985 processor to be halted.
5986 @end deffn
5987
5988 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5989 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5990 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5991 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5992 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5993 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5994
5995 @example
5996 at91samd set-security enable
5997 @end example
5998 @end deffn
5999
6000 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6001 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6002 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6003 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6004 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6005 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6006 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6007 in order to disable this feature.
6008
6009 @example
6010 at91samd eeprom
6011 at91samd eeprom 1024
6012 @end example
6013 @end deffn
6014
6015 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6016 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6017 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6018 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6019 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6020 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6021
6022 @example
6023 at91samd bootloader
6024 at91samd bootloader 16384
6025 @end example
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6029 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6030 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6031 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6032 @end deffn
6033
6034 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6035 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6036 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6037 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6038 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6039 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6040 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6041 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6042
6043 @example
6044 # Read user row
6045 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6046 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6047 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6048 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6049 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6050 # byte unchanged
6051 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6052 @end example
6053 @end deffn
6054
6055 @end deffn
6056
6057 @anchor{at91sam3}
6058 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6059 @cindex at91sam3
6060 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6061 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6062 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6063 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6064 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6065 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6066 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6067 chips are confirmed.}
6068
6069 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6070 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6071 the following fixed locations:
6072
6073 @example
6074 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6075 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6076 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6077 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6078 @end example
6079
6080 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6081 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6082 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6083
6084 @itemize
6085 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6086 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6087 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6088 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6089 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6090 @end itemize
6091
6092 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6093
6094 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6095 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6096 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6097 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6098 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6099 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6100 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6101
6102 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6103 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6104 @end deffn
6105
6106 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6107 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6108 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6109 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6110 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6111 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6112 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6113 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6114 @end deffn
6115
6116 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6117 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6118 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6119 @end deffn
6120 @end deffn
6121
6122 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6123 @cindex at91sam4
6124 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6125 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6126 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6127 @end deffn
6128
6129 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6130 @cindex at91sam4l
6131 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6132 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6133 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6134
6135 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6136 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6137 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6138 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6139 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6140 @end deffn
6141 @end deffn
6142
6143 @anchor{atsame5}
6144 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6145 @cindex atsame5
6146 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6147 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6148 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6149
6150 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6151 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6152 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6153
6154 @example
6155 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6156 @end example
6157
6158 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6159 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6160 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6161 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6162 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6163 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6164
6165 @example
6166 atsame5 bootloader
6167 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6168 @end example
6169 @end deffn
6170
6171 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6172 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6173 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6174 processor to be halted.
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6178 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6179 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6180 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6181 @end deffn
6182
6183 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6184 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6185 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6186 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6187 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6188 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6189 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6190 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6191
6192 @example
6193 # Read
6194 >atsame5 userpage
6195 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6196 # Write
6197 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6198 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6199 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6200 # bytes)
6201 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6202 @end example
6203 @end deffn
6204
6205 @end deffn
6206
6207 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6208 @cindex atsamv
6209 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6210 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6211 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6212 @end deffn
6213
6214 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6215 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6216 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6217 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6218 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6219
6220 @example
6221 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6222 @end example
6223
6224 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6225 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6226
6227 @itemize
6228 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6229 @item @var{banks}
6230 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6231 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6232 @item @var{pages_size}
6233 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6234 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6235 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6236 @end itemize
6237
6238 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6239 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6240 will be autoconfigured.
6241 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6242
6243 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6244 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6245 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6246 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6247 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6248
6249 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6250 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6251 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6252 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6253 are not truly general purpose).
6254 @quotation Note
6255 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6256 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6257 @end quotation
6258 @end deffn
6259 @end deffn
6260
6261 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6262 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6263 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6264 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6265 @end deffn
6266
6267 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6268 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6269 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6270 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6271
6272 @example
6273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6274 @end example
6275
6276 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6277 each single sector one by one.
6278
6279 @example
6280 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6281 @end example
6282
6283 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6284 @end deffn
6285
6286 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6287 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6288 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6289 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6290 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6291 starts at address 0.
6292
6293 @example
6294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6295 @end example
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6299 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6300 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6301 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6302 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6303 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6304 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6305 and programming the serial flash.
6306
6307 @example
6308 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6309 @end example
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6313 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6314 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6315 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6316 autoconfigures itself.
6317 @example
6318 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6319 @end example
6320 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6321 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6322 this via the following command:
6323 @example
6324 efm32 debuglock num
6325 @end example
6326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6327 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6328 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6329 supported.}
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6333 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6334 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6335 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6336 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6337 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6338
6339 @example
6340 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6341 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6342 @end example
6343
6344 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6345 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6346 @end deffn
6347
6348 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6349 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6350 is an uncommon operation.}
6351 @end deffn
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6355 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6356 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6357 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6358 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6359 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6360 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6361
6362 @example
6363 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6364 @end example
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6368 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6369 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6370 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6371 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6372 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6373 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6374 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6375 characters) ignored.
6376
6377 @example
6378 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6379 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6380 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6381 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6382 @end example
6383 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6384 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6385 @end deffn
6386
6387 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6388 @cindex kinetis
6389 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6390 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6391 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6392 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6393 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6394 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6395
6396 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6397 @itemize
6398 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6399 @end itemize
6400
6401 @example
6402 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6403 @end example
6404
6405 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6406 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6407 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6408 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6409 @end deffn
6410
6411 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6412 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6413 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6414 set by 'flash protect' command.
6415 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6416 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6417 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6418 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6419 with the rest of a flash image.
6420 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6424 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6425 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6426 @end deffn
6427
6428 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6429 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6430 and examine-fail event.
6431 @end deffn
6432
6433 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6434 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6435 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6439 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6440 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6441 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6442 command completes.
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6446 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6447 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6448 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6449 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6450
6451 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6452 Program Partition command.
6453
6454 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6455 Reset the device after partition setting.
6456
6457 Show partition size:
6458 @example
6459 kinetis nvm_partition info
6460 @end example
6461
6462 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6463 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6464 @example
6465 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6466 @end example
6467
6468 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6469 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6470 @example
6471 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6472 @end example
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6476 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6477 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6481 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6482 Command disables watchdog timer.
6483 @end deffn
6484 @end deffn
6485
6486 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6487 @cindex kinetis_ke
6488 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6489 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6490 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6491 autoconfigures itself.
6492 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6493
6494 @example
6495 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6496 @end example
6497
6498 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6499 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6500 @end deffn
6501
6502 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6503 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6504 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6505 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6506 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6510 Command disables watchdog timer.
6511 @end deffn
6512 @end deffn
6513
6514 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6515 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6516 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6517 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6518 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6519
6520 @quotation Note
6521 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6522 driver:
6523 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6524 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6525 @end quotation
6526
6527 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6528 which must appear in the following order:
6529
6530 @itemize
6531 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6532 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6533 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6534 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6535 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6536 LPC43x[2357])
6537 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6538 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6539 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6540 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6541 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6542 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6543 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6544 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6545 at which the core is running
6546 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6547 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6548 @quotation Note
6549 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6550 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6551 However, if you do provide it,
6552 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6553 @end quotation
6554 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6555 ROM IAP entry point.
6556 @end itemize
6557
6558 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6559
6560 @example
6561 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6562 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6563 @end example
6564
6565 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6566 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6567 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6568 @end deffn
6569 @end deffn
6570
6571 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6572 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6573 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6574 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6575 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6576 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6577
6578 @example
6579 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6580 @end example
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6584 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6585 from NXP.
6586
6587 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6588 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6589 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6590 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6591 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6592 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6593 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6594 you start the PLL.
6595
6596 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6597
6598 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6599 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6600 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6601
6602 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6603 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6604 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6605 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6606 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6607 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6608 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6609
6610 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6611 @example
6612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6613 @end example
6614
6615 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6616 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6617 @code{flash banks} command.
6618
6619 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6620 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6621 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6622 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6623 a known signature.
6624 Example:
6625 @example
6626 lpc2900 signature 0
6627 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6628 @end example
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6632 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6633 saves it to a file in binary format.
6634 Example:
6635 @example
6636 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6637 @end example
6638 @end deffn
6639
6640 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6641 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6642 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6643 command:
6644
6645 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6646 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6647 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6648 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6649
6650 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6651 Example:
6652 @example
6653 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6654 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6655 @end example
6656 @end deffn
6657
6658 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6659 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6660 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6661 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6662 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6663 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6664 912 bytes.
6665 @quotation Attention
6666 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6667 @end quotation
6668 Example:
6669 @example
6670 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6671 @end example
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6675 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6676 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6677 after the next power cycle.
6678 @quotation Attention
6679 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6680 @end quotation
6681 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6682 Example:
6683 @example
6684 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6685 flash info 0
6686 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6687 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6688 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6689 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6690 @end example
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6694 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6695 effective after the next power cycle.
6696 @quotation Attention
6697 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6698 @end quotation
6699 Examples:
6700 @example
6701 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6702 @end example
6703 @end deffn
6704 @end deffn
6705
6706 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6707 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6708 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6709 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6710
6711 @example
6712 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6713 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6714 @end example
6715
6716 @itemize @bullet
6717 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6718 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6719 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6720 @end itemize
6721
6722 Example usage:
6723 @example
6724 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6725 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6726 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6727 @} else @{
6728 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6729 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6730 @}
6731 @end example
6732 @end deffn
6733
6734 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6735 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6736 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6737 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6738 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6739 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6740
6741 @example
6742 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6743 @end example
6744
6745 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6746 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6747 only the main program flash.
6748
6749 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6750 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6751 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6755 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6756 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6757 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6758
6759 To erase and program the BSL:
6760 @example
6761 msp432 bsl unlock
6762 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6763 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6764 msp432 bsl lock
6765 @end example
6766 @end deffn
6767 @end deffn
6768
6769 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6770 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6771 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6772 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6773 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6774 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6775 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6776 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6777 also have division into regions: main and info.
6778 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6779 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6780
6781 @example
6782 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6783 @end example
6784
6785 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6786
6787 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6788 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6792 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6796 Erase all userflash including info region.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6800 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6804 Check sectors protect.
6805 @end deffn
6806
6807 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6808 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6809 @end deffn
6810
6811 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6812 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6816 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6820 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6821 @end deffn
6822
6823 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6824 Show information about flash driver.
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6830 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6831 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6832 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6833 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6834
6835 @example
6836 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6837 @end example
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6841 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6842 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6843 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6844 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6845
6846 @example
6847 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6848 @end example
6849
6850 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6851
6852 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6853 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6854 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6855 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6856 code.
6857 @end deffn
6858
6859 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6860 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @end deffn
6864
6865 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6866 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6867 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6868
6869 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6870 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6871 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6872 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6873
6874 @example
6875 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6876 @end example
6877 @end deffn
6878
6879 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6880 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6881 and integrate flash memory.
6882
6883 @example
6884 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6886 @end example
6887
6888 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6889 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6890 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6891 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6892 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6893 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6894 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6895 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6896 @end deffn
6897 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6898 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6899 This will remove any Code Protection.
6900 @end deffn
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6904 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6905 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6906 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6907 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6908
6909 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6910 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6911
6912 @example
6913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6914 @end example
6915
6916 psoc4-specific commands
6917 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6918 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6919
6920 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6921 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6922
6923 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6924 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6925 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6926
6927 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6928 @end deffn
6929
6930 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6931 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6932
6933 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6934 @end deffn
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6938 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6939 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6940 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6941 apart from the base address.
6942
6943 @example
6944 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6945 @end example
6946
6947 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6948 @quotation Attention
6949 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6950 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6951 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6952 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6953 @end quotation
6954
6955 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6956
6957 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6958 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6959 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6960 @end deffn
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6964 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6965 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6966 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6967 apart from the base address.
6968
6969 @example
6970 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6971 $_TARGETNAME
6972 @end example
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6976 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6977 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6978 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6979
6980 @example
6981 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6982 @end example
6983
6984 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6985
6986 @itemize
6987 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6988 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6989 @end itemize
6990
6991 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6992
6993 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6994 @quotation Attention
6995 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6996 after successful write.
6997 @end quotation
6998 @end deffn
6999
7000 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7001 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7002 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7003 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7004
7005 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7006 @itemize @bullet
7007 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7008 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7009 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7010 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7011 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7012 row size: 512 bytes.
7013 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7014 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7015 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7016 operation will erase row automatically.
7017 @end itemize
7018
7019 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7020 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7021
7022 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7023
7024 @example
7025 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7026 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7027 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7028 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7029 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7030 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7031 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7032 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7033 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7034 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7035 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7036 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7037
7038 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7039 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7040 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7041 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7042 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7043 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7044 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7045 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7046 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7047 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7048 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7049 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7050 @end example
7051
7052 psoc6-specific commands
7053 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7054 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7055 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7056 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7057 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7058 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7059 @end deffn
7060
7061 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7062 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7063 by @command{flash banks}.
7064 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7065 @end deffn
7066 @end deffn
7067
7068 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7069 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7070 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7071 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7072 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7073
7074 @example
7075 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7076 @end example
7077 @end deffn
7078
7079 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7080 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7081 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7082 and SWD interface.
7083 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7084 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7085
7086 @example
7087 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7088 @end example
7089
7090 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7091
7092 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7093 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7094 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7095 @end deffn
7096
7097 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7098 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7099 @end deffn
7100 @end deffn
7101
7102 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7103 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7104 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7105 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7106 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7107
7108 @example
7109 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7110 @end example
7111
7112 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7113 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7114 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7115 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7116 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7117 disabled.
7118
7119 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7120 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7121 @quotation Warning
7122 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7123 applied to all of them.
7124 @end quotation
7125 @end deffn
7126 @end deffn
7127
7128 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7129 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7130 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7131 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7132 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7133 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7134
7135 @example
7136 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7137 @end example
7138
7139 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7140 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7141 the flash driver.
7142
7143 @example
7144 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7145 @end example
7146
7147 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7148 as per the following example.
7149 @example
7150 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7151 @end example
7152
7153 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7154
7155 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7156 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7157 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7158 @end deffn
7159
7160 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7161 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7162 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7163 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7164 @end deffn
7165
7166 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7167 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7168 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7172 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7173 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7174 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7178 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7179 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7180 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7181 @end deffn
7182
7183 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7184 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7185 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7186 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7187 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7188 @end deffn
7189 @end deffn
7190
7191 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7192 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7193 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7194 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7195 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7196
7197 @example
7198 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7199 @end example
7200
7201 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7202 as per the following example.
7203 @example
7204 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7205 @end example
7206
7207 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7208 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7209 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7213 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7214 the flash driver.
7215
7216 @example
7217 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7218 @end example
7219
7220 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7221
7222 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7223 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7224 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7225 @end deffn
7226
7227 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7228 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7229 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7230 @end deffn
7231
7232 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7233 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7238 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7239 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7243 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7244 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7245 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7246 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7247 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7248 @end deffn
7249
7250 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7251 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7253 @end deffn
7254 @end deffn
7255
7256 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7257 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7258 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7259 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7260 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7261
7262 @example
7263 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7264 @end example
7265
7266 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7267 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7268 the flash driver.
7269
7270 @example
7271 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7272 @end example
7273
7274 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7275
7276 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7277 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7278 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7279 @end deffn
7280
7281 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7282 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7283 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7287 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7289 @end deffn
7290
7291 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7292 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7293 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7294 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7295 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7296
7297 Example usage:
7298 @example
7299 # read OPTSR_CUR
7300 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7301 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7302 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7303 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7304 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7305 @end example
7306 @end deffn
7307
7308 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7309 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7310 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7311 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7312 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7313 will be touched).
7314
7315 Example usage:
7316 @example
7317 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7318 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7319 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7320 @end example
7321 @end deffn
7322 @end deffn
7323
7324 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7325 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7326 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7327 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7328 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7329
7330 @example
7331 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7332 @end example
7333
7334 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7335 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7336 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7337 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7338 second bank.
7339
7340 @example
7341 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7342 @end example
7343
7344 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7345
7346 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7347 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7348 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7349 @end deffn
7350
7351 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7352 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7353 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7354 @end deffn
7355
7356 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7357 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7358 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7359 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7360 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7361 @end deffn
7362 @end deffn
7363
7364 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7365 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7366 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7367 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7368 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7369 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7370
7371 @example
7372 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7373 @end example
7374
7375 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7376 as per the following example.
7377 @example
7378 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7379 @end example
7380
7381 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7382 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7383 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7384 @end deffn
7385
7386 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7387 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7388 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7389 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7390
7391 @example
7392 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7393 @end example
7394
7395 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7396
7397 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7398 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7399 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7400
7401 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7402 @end deffn
7403
7404 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7405 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7406 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7407
7408 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7412 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7413 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7414 @end deffn
7415
7416 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7417 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7418 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7419 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7420
7421 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7422 @example
7423 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7424 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7425 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7426 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7427 @end example
7428
7429 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7430 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7431 @end deffn
7432
7433 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7434 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7435 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7436 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7437 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7438
7439 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7440
7441 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7442 @example
7443 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7444 @end example
7445
7446 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7447 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7448 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7449 @end deffn
7450
7451 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7452 List the protected areas using WRP.
7453 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7454 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7455 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7456
7457 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7458 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7459 in single or dual-banks mode.
7460 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7461 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7462
7463 @end deffn
7464
7465 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7466 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7467 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7468 @end deffn
7469
7470 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7471 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7472 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7473 the TrustZone status.
7474 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7475 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7476 @end deffn
7477 @end deffn
7478
7479 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7480 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7481 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7482 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7483 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7484
7485 @example
7486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7487 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7488 @end example
7489
7490 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7491 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7492 for the specified flash bank.
7493 @end deffn
7494 @end deffn
7495
7496 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7497 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7498 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7499 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7500 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7501
7502 @example
7503 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7504 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7505 @end example
7506
7507 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7508 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7509 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7510
7511 @itemize @bullet
7512 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7513 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7514 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7515 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7516 @end itemize
7517 @end deffn
7518
7519 @end deffn
7520
7521 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7522 @cindex str9xpec
7523
7524 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7525 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7526 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7527 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7528
7529 Here is some background info to help
7530 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7531 the str9:
7532 @enumerate
7533 @item
7534 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7535 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7536 @item
7537 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7538 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7539 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7540 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7541 @end enumerate
7542
7543 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7544 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7545 configured for flash bank 0.
7546 @example
7547 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7548 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7549 adapter assert srst
7550 # turn off target polling
7551 poll off
7552 # disable str9 core
7553 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7554 # read option bytes
7555 str9xpec options_read 0
7556 # re-enable str9 core
7557 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7558 poll on
7559 reset halt
7560 @end example
7561 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7562 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7563 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7564 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7565
7566 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7567
7568 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7569 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7570 @end deffn
7571
7572 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7573 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7574 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7575 @end deffn
7576
7577 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7578 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7579 erase the device.
7580 @end deffn
7581
7582 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7583 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7584 @end deffn
7585
7586 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7587 Configure str9 boot bank.
7588 @end deffn
7589
7590 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7591 Configure str9 lvd source.
7592 @end deffn
7593
7594 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7595 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7596 @end deffn
7597
7598 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7599 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7600 @end deffn
7601
7602 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7603 Read str9 option bytes.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7607 Write str9 option bytes.
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7611 unlock str9 device.
7612 @end deffn
7613
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7617 @cindex swm050
7618 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7619
7620 @example
7621 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7622 @end example
7623
7624 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7625
7626 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7627 Erases the entire flash bank.
7628 @end deffn
7629
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632
7633 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7634 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7635 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7636 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7637
7638 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7639
7640 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7641 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7645 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7649 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7650 the flash clock.
7651 @end deffn
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7655 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7656 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7657 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7658 correct bank config.
7659
7660 @example
7661 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7662 @end example
7663 @end deffn
7664
7665 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7666 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7667 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7668 @end deffn
7669
7670 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7671 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7672 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7673
7674 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7675
7676 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7677 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7678 @end deffn
7679
7680 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7681 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7682 @end deffn
7683
7684 @end deffn
7685
7686 @section NAND Flash Commands
7687 @cindex NAND
7688
7689 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7690 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7691 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7692
7693 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7694 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7695 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7696 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7697 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7698 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7699
7700 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7701 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7702 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7703 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7704 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7705 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7706 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7707 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7708 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7709 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7710
7711 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7712 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7713 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7714 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7715 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7716 every 512 bytes of data.
7717
7718 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7719 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7720 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7721 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7722 ECC mode is used.
7723
7724 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7725 @enumerate
7726 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7727 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7728 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7729 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7730 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7731 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7732 to access that device.
7733 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7734 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7735 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7736 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7737 de-brick a board.
7738 @end enumerate
7739
7740 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7741 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7742 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7743 are only 32 bits wide.
7744 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7745 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7746 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7747 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7748
7749 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7750 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7751 @cindex NAND configuration
7752
7753 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7754 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7755 OpenOCD has initialized.
7756
7757 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7758 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7759 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7760 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7761 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7762 they were a single (larger) device.
7763 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7764 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7765
7766 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7767 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7768 configuration files, not interactively.
7769
7770 @itemize @bullet
7771 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7772 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7773 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7774 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7775 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7776 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7777 commands to the NAND controller.
7778 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7779 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7780 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7781 for more information.
7782 @end itemize
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7786 Prints a summary of each device declared
7787 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7788 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7789 @example
7790 > nand list
7791 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7792 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7793 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7794 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7795 >
7796 @end example
7797 @end deffn
7798
7799 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7800 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7801 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7802 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7803 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7804 it with most other NAND commands.
7805 @end deffn
7806
7807 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7808
7809 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7810 @cindex NAND reading
7811 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7812 starting at the specified offset.
7813 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7814
7815 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7816 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7817
7818 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7819 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7820 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7821
7822 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7823 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7824 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7825 method which handled that error correction.
7826
7827 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7828 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7829 @itemize @bullet
7830 @item no oob_* parameter
7831 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7832 @item @code{oob_raw}
7833 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7834 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7835 spare areas associated with each data page.
7836 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7837 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7838 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7839 @item @code{oob_only}
7840 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7841 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7842 spare areas associated with each data page.
7843 @end itemize
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7847 @cindex NAND erasing
7848 @cindex NAND programming
7849 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7850 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7851 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7852 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7853 If those parameters are not specified,
7854 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7855 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7856
7857 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7858 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7859 block marker.
7860 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7861 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7862 @end deffn
7863
7864 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7865 @cindex NAND writing
7866 @cindex NAND programming
7867 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7868 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7869 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7870 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7871
7872 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7873 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7874
7875 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7876 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7877 past the end of the device.
7878 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7879 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7880 if that's being written.)
7881
7882 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7883 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7884 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7885
7886 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7887 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7888 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7889 @itemize @bullet
7890 @item no oob_* parameter
7891 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7892 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7893 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7894 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7895 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7896 @item @code{oob_only}
7897 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7898 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7899 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7900 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7901 @item @code{oob_raw}
7902 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7903 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7904 un-altered OOB.
7905 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7906 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7907 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7908 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7909 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7910 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7911 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7912 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7913 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7914 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7915 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7916 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7917 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7918 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7919 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7920 @end itemize
7921 @end deffn
7922
7923 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7924 @cindex NAND verification
7925 @cindex NAND programming
7926 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7927 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7928 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7929
7930 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7931 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7932
7933 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7934 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7935 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7936 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7937 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7938
7939 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7940 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7941 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7942
7943 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7944 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7945 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7946 be removed in a future release.
7947 @end deffn
7948
7949 @subsection Other NAND commands
7950 @cindex NAND other commands
7951
7952 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7953 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7954 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7955 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7956 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7957 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7958 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7959 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7960
7961 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7962 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7963 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7967 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7968 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7969 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7970 status for each block.
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7974 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7975 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7976
7977 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7978 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7979 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7980 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7981 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7982
7983 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7984 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7985 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7986 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7987 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7988 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7989 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7990 @end deffn
7991
7992 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7993 @subsection NAND Driver List
7994 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7995 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7996 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7997
7998 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7999 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8000 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8001 address of the ECC controller.
8002 @example
8003 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8004 @end example
8005 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8006 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8007 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8008 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8009 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8010 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8011 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8012 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8013 @end deffn
8014 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8015 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8016 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8017 @end deffn
8018
8019 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8020 properly configured for input or output.
8021 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8022 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8023 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8024 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8025 @end deffn
8026 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8027 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8028 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8029 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8030 @end deffn
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8034 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8035 chips from Texas Instruments.
8036 It takes three extra parameters:
8037 address of the NAND chip;
8038 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8039 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8040 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8041 @example
8042 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8043 @end example
8044 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8045 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8046 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8047 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8048 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8049 @end deffn
8050
8051 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8052 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8053 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8054 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8055 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8056 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8057 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8061 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8062 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8063 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8064 @end deffn
8065 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8066
8067 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8068 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8069 should work for this chip as well.
8070 @end deffn
8071
8072 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8073 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8074 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8075 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8076 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8077 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8078 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8079 @example
8080 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8081 @end example
8082 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8083 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8084 without parameter query status.
8085 @end deffn
8086 @end deffn
8087
8088 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8089 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8090 parameter: the address of the controller.
8091 @example
8092 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8093 @end example
8094 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8095 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8096 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8097 change any behavior.
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8101 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8102 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8103 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8104 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8105 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8106 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8107 specialized commands.
8108 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8109 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8110 change any behavior.
8111 @end deffn
8112
8113 @node Flash Programming
8114 @chapter Flash Programming
8115
8116 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8117 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8118 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8119
8120 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8121 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8122
8123 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8124 @enumerate
8125 @item 'init' is executed.
8126 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8127 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8128 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8129 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8130 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8131 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8132 @end enumerate
8133
8134 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8135
8136 @example
8137 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8138 # are optional parameters
8139 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8140 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8141
8142 # binary files need the flash address passing
8143 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8144 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8145 @end example
8146
8147 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8148 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8149 @cindex PLD
8150 @cindex FPGA
8151
8152 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8153 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8154 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8155 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8156 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8157 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8158 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8159
8160 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8161
8162 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8163 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8164 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8165
8166 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8167 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8168
8169 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8170 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8171 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8172 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8173 behavior.
8174 @end deffn
8175
8176 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8177 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8178 @end deffn
8179
8180 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8181 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8182 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8183 @end deffn
8184
8185 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8186
8187 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8188 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8189 that particular type of PLD.
8190
8191 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8192 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8193 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8194
8195 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8196 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8197 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8198
8199 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8200 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8201 for FPGA @var{num}.
8202 @end deffn
8203 @end deffn
8204
8205 @node General Commands
8206 @chapter General Commands
8207 @cindex commands
8208
8209 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8210 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8211 commands are documented elsewhere.
8212
8213 Intent:
8214 @itemize @bullet
8215 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8216 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8217 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8218 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8219
8220 @item @b{From the human}
8221 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8222 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8223
8224 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8225 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8226 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8227
8228 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8229 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8230 port is 5555.
8231 @end itemize
8232
8233
8234 @section Server Commands
8235
8236 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8237 Exits the current telnet session.
8238 @end deffn
8239
8240 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8241 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8242 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8243 Not every command provides helptext.
8244
8245 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8246 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8247 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8248 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8249 @end deffn
8250
8251 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8252 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8253 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8254 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8255 Useful in connection with script files
8256 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8257 @end deffn
8258
8259 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8260 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8261 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8262 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8263
8264 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8265 @example
8266 # redefine shutdown
8267 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8268 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8269 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8270 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8271 original_shutdown
8272 @}
8273 @end example
8274 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8275 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8276 @end deffn
8277
8278 @anchor{debuglevel}
8279 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8280 @cindex message level
8281 Display debug level.
8282 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8283 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8284 Level 0 is error messages only;
8285 level 1 adds warnings;
8286 level 2 adds informational messages;
8287 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8288 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8289 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8290 the command line along with the location of that log
8291 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8292 @xref{Running}.
8293 @end deffn
8294
8295 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8296 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8297 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8298 @example
8299 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8300 @end example
8301 @end deffn
8302
8303 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8304 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8305 the default log output channel is stderr.
8306 @end deffn
8307
8308 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8309 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8310 @end deffn
8311
8312 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8313 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8314 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8315 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8316 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8317 @end deffn
8318
8319 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8320 @section Target State handling
8321 @cindex reset
8322 @cindex halt
8323 @cindex target initialization
8324
8325 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8326 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8327 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8328 a current target which is used to perform the
8329 various operations. The current target may be changed
8330 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8331 target which should become current.
8332
8333 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8334 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8335 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8336 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8337 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8338
8339 @emph{With no arguments}:
8340 list all available registers for the current target,
8341 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8342 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8343 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8344 are flagged as such.
8345
8346 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8347 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8348 bypassing any internal cache.
8349
8350 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8351 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8352 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8353 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8354 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8355 relevant module will flush such values.
8356
8357 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8358 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8359
8360 @example
8361 > reg
8362 ===== ARM registers
8363 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8364 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8365 (2) r2 (/32)
8366 ...
8367 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8368 >
8369 @end example
8370 @end deffn
8371
8372 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8373 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8374 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8375 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8376 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8377 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8378 (and enter debug mode).
8379 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8380
8381 @quotation Warning
8382 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8383 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8384 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8385 power mode by gating the core clock;
8386 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8387
8388 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8389 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8390 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8391 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8392 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8393 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8394
8395 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8396 work with a JTAG debugger.
8397 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8398 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8399 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8400 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8401 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8402 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8403 @end quotation
8404
8405 @end deffn
8406
8407 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8408 Resume the target at its current code position,
8409 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8410 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8411 @end deffn
8412
8413 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8414 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8415 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8416 @end deffn
8417
8418 @anchor{resetcommand}
8419 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8420 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8421 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8422 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8423 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8424 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8425 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8426
8427 The optional parameter specifies what should
8428 happen after the reset.
8429 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8430 The other options will not work on all systems.
8431 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8432
8433 @itemize @minus
8434 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8435 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8436 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8437 @end itemize
8438 @end deffn
8439
8440 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8441 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8442 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8443 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8444 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8445 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8446 state.
8447 @end deffn
8448
8449 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8450 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8451 Set values of reset signals.
8452 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8453 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8454 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8455 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8456
8457 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8458 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8459 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8460 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8461 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8462 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8463 the signal will not be modified.
8464
8465 @quotation Note
8466 TRST is specially handled.
8467 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8468 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8469 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8470 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8471 instead of the TRST signal.
8472 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8473 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8474 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8475 with handlers for that event.
8476 @end quotation
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8480 @section Memory access commands
8481 @cindex memory access
8482
8483 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8484 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8485 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8486 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8487
8488 @enumerate
8489 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8490 to change the current target.
8491 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8492 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8493 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8494 @end enumerate
8495
8496 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8497 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8498 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8499 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8500 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8501 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8502 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8503 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8504 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8505 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8506 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8507 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8508 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8509 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8510 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8511 @end deffn
8512
8513 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8514 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8515 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8516 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8517 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8518 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8519 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8520 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8521 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8522 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8523 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8524 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8525 @end deffn
8526
8527 @anchor{imageaccess}
8528 @section Image loading commands
8529 @cindex image loading
8530 @cindex image dumping
8531
8532 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8533 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8534 binary file named @var{filename}.
8535 @end deffn
8536
8537 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8538 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8539 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8540 @end deffn
8541
8542 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8543 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8544 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8545 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8546 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8547 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8548 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8549 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8550 separately.
8551 @end deffn
8552
8553 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8554 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8555 The file format may optionally be specified
8556 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8557 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8558 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8559 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8560 @example
8561 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8562 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8563 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8564 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8565 $address $length
8566 @}
8567 @end example
8568 @end deffn
8569
8570 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8571 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8572 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8573 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8574 The file format may optionally be specified
8575 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8576 @end deffn
8577
8578 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8579 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8580 The file format may optionally be specified
8581 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8582 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8586 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8587 The file format may optionally be specified
8588 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8589 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592
8593 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8594 @cindex breakpoint
8595 @cindex watchpoint
8596
8597 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8598 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8599 watchpoints.
8600 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8601
8602 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8603 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8604 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8605 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8606 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8607 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8608
8609 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8610 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8611 @end deffn
8612
8613 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8614 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8618 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8622 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8623 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8624 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8625 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8626 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8627 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8628 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8629 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8630 @end deffn
8631
8632
8633 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8634
8635 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8636 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8637 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8638 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8639 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8640 running, can be used.
8641 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8642 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8643 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8644
8645 @quotation Note
8646 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8647 @end quotation
8648
8649 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8650 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8651 communication, respectively.
8652
8653 @quotation Note
8654 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8655 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8656 example.
8657 @end quotation
8658
8659 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8660 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8661 of TCP/IP connections.
8662
8663 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8664 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8665 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8666 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8667 @var{size} bytes.
8668 @end deffn
8669
8670 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8671 Start RTT.
8672 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8673 @end deffn
8674
8675 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8676 Stop RTT.
8677 @end deffn
8678
8679 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8680 Display the polling interval.
8681 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8682 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8683 checked for new data.
8684 @end deffn
8685
8686 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8687 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8688 @end deffn
8689
8690 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8691 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8692 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8693 @end deffn
8694
8695 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8696 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8697 @end deffn
8698
8699 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8700 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8701 @end deffn
8702
8703 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8704 on the target device.
8705
8706 @example
8707 resume
8708
8709 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8710 rtt start
8711
8712 rtt server start 9090 0
8713 @end example
8714
8715 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8716 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8717 TCP/IP port 9090.
8718
8719
8720 @section Misc Commands
8721
8722 @cindex profiling
8723 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8724 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8725 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8726 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8727 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8728 limit the address range.
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @deffn {Command} {version}
8732 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8733 @end deffn
8734
8735 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8736 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8737 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8738 @end deffn
8739
8740 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8741 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8742 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8743 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8744
8745 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8746 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8747 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8748 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8749
8750 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8751 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8752 @cindex tracing
8753 @cindex ETM
8754 @cindex ETB
8755
8756 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8757 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8758 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8759
8760 @itemize
8761 @item
8762 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8763 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8764 supports such an interface.
8765 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8766 and trace port support.)
8767 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8768 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8769 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8770 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8771 in the board-specific configuration file.
8772 @item
8773 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8774 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8775 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8776 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8777 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8778 @end itemize
8779
8780 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8781
8782 @quotation Issues
8783 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8784 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8785
8786 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8787 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8788 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8789 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8790 dummy trace port driver}.
8791
8792 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8793 as well as tracing only during specific states
8794 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8795
8796 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8797 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8798 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8799 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8800 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8801
8802 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8803 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8804 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8805 this original style of JTAG access.
8806 @end quotation
8807
8808 @subsection ETM Configuration
8809 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8810
8811 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8812 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8813 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8814
8815 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8816 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8817 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8818 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8819 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8820 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8821 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8822 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8823 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8824
8825 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8826 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8827 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8828
8829 @quotation Warning
8830 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8831 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8832 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8833 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8834 @end quotation
8835
8836 @quotation Note
8837 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8838 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8839 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8840 what CPU activities are traced.
8841 @end quotation
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8845 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8846 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8847 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8848 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8852 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8853 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8854 Did trace data overflow?
8855 Was it triggered?
8856 @end deffn
8857
8858 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8859 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8860 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8861 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8862 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8863
8864 @itemize
8865 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8866 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8867 The value is one of
8868 @option{none} (save nothing),
8869 @option{data} (save data),
8870 @option{address} (save addresses),
8871 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8872 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8873 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8874 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8875 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8876 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8877 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8878 trace stream without an image of the code.
8879 @end itemize
8880 @end deffn
8881
8882 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8883 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8884 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8885 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8886 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8887
8888 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8889 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8890 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8891 @end deffn
8892
8893 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8894
8895 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8896 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8897 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8898
8899 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8900 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8901 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8902 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8903 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8904 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8905 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8906
8907 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8908
8909 @itemize
8910 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8911 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8912 for instruction access within that function's body.
8913 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8914 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8915 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8916 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8917 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8918 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8919 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8920 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8921 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8922 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8923 @item @emph{... more}
8924 @end itemize
8925
8926 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8927 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8928
8929 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8930 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8931 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8932 @end deffn
8933
8934 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8935 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8936 @end deffn
8937
8938 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8939 Opens an image file.
8940 @end deffn
8941
8942 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8943 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8944 @end deffn
8945
8946 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8947 Starts trace data collection.
8948 @end deffn
8949
8950 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8951 Stops trace data collection.
8952 @end deffn
8953
8954 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8955 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8956
8957 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8958
8959 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8960 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8961 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8962 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8963 any trace data collection.}
8964 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8965 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8966 @end deffn
8967 @end deffn
8968
8969 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8970 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8971 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8972 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8973 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8974 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8975 @end deffn
8976 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8977 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8978 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8979 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8980 trace trigger becomes active.
8981
8982 @itemize
8983 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8984 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8985 afterwards.
8986 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8987 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8988 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8989 what caused that event to happen.
8990 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8991 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8992 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8993 how the event caused trouble.
8994 @end itemize
8995 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8996 @end deffn
8997
8998 @end deffn
8999
9000 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9001 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9002 @cindex CTI
9003
9004 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9005 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9006 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9007 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9008 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9009 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9010
9011 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9012 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9013 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9014 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9015 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9016 including additional configuration.
9017 @end deffn
9018
9019 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9020 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9024 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9028 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9032 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9036 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9037 @end deffn
9038
9039 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9040 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9041 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9042 @end deffn
9043
9044 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9045 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9046 of the CTI.
9047 @end deffn
9048
9049 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9050 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9051 useful in TCL scripting.
9052 @end deffn
9053
9054 @section Generic ARM
9055 @cindex ARM
9056
9057 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9058 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9059 commands that may be available.
9060
9061 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9062 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9063 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9064 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9065 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9066 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9067 @end deffn
9068
9069 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9070 @cindex disassemble
9071 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9072 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9073 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9074 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9075 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9076 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9077 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9078
9079 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9080 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9081 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9082 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9083 with a handful of exceptions.
9084 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9085 @end deffn
9086
9087 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9088 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9089 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9090 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9091 and using the MCR instruction.
9092 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9093 an ARM register.)
9094 @end deffn
9095
9096 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9097 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9098 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9099 and the MRC instruction.
9100 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9101 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9102 an ARM register.)
9103 @end deffn
9104
9105 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9106 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9107 core mode if necessary.
9108 @end deffn
9109
9110 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9111 @cindex ARM semihosting
9112 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9113
9114 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9115 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9116 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9117 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9118 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9119 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9123 @cindex ARM semihosting
9124 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9125
9126 @example
9127 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9128 @end example
9129
9130 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9131 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9132 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9133 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9134 @end deffn
9135
9136 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9137 @cindex ARM semihosting
9138 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9139 status.
9140
9141 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9142 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9143 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9144 debugger.
9145 @end deffn
9146
9147 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9148 @cindex ARM semihosting
9149 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9150
9151 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9152 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9153 the value returned by the target.
9154
9155 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9156 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9157 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9158 encountering a break.
9159
9160 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9161 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9162 to the debugger.
9163 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9164 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9165 request or equivalent").
9166
9167 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9168 this option (default: disabled).
9169 @end deffn
9170
9171 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9172 @cindex ARMv4
9173 @cindex ARMv5
9174
9175 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9176 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9177 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9178 variant.
9179
9180 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9181 @cindex ARM7
9182 @cindex ARM9
9183
9184 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9185 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9186 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9187 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9188
9189 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9190 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9191 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9192 instead of breakpoints.
9193 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9194
9195 This should be
9196 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9197 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9198 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9199 @end deffn
9200
9201 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9202 @cindex DCC
9203 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9204 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9205 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9206
9207 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9208 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9209 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9210 @end deffn
9211
9212 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9213 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9214 that don't check completion of the operation.
9215 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9216
9217 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9218 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9219 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9220 @end deffn
9221
9222 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9223 @cindex ARM9
9224
9225 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9226 integer processors.
9227 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9228
9229 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9230 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9231 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9232 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9233
9234 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9235 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9236 @cindex vector_catch
9237 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9238 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9239 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9240 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9241 to those hardware vectors.
9242
9243 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9244 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9245 vector catch hardware to intercept
9246 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9247 @option{none} of them,
9248 or a list with one or more of the following:
9249 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9250 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9251 @end deffn
9252
9253 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9254 @cindex ARM920T
9255
9256 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9257 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9258 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9259 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9260 and ARM9 commands.
9261
9262 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9263 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9264 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9265 @end deffn
9266
9267 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9268 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9269 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9270 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9271 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9272 (Not all registers can be written.)
9273 @end deffn
9274
9275 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9276 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9277 @end deffn
9278
9279 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9280 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9284 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9285
9286 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9287 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9288 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9289 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9290 and ARM9 commands.
9291
9292 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9293 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9294
9295 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9296 Print information about the caches found.
9297 @end deffn
9298
9299 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9300 @cindex ARM966E
9301
9302 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9303 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9304 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9305 and ARM9 commands.
9306
9307 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9308 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9309 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9310 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9311 ARM966E-S TRM.
9312 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9313 as required for BIST support.
9314 @end deffn
9315
9316 @subsection XScale specific commands
9317 @cindex XScale
9318
9319 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9320
9321 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9322 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9323 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9324 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9325 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9326 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9327 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9328
9329 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9330 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9331 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9332 the mini-IC.
9333
9334 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9335 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9336 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9337 code layout in memory:
9338 @example
9339 _vectors:
9340 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9341 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9342 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9343 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9344 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9345 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9346 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9347 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9348 .org 0x100
9349 .long real_reset_vector
9350 .long real_ui_handler
9351 .long real_swi_handler
9352 .long real_pf_abort
9353 .long real_data_abort
9354 .long 0 /* unused */
9355 .long real_irq_handler
9356 .long real_fiq_handler
9357 @end example
9358
9359 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9360 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9361 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9362 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9363 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9364 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9365 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9366 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9367 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9368 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9369 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9370 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9371 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9372 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9373 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9374 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9375 software.
9376
9377 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9378 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9379 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9380 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9381
9382 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9383 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9384 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9385 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9386 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9387 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9388 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9389 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9390 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9391
9392 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9393 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9394
9395 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9396 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9397 @end deffn
9398
9399 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9400 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9401 @end deffn
9402
9403 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9404 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9405 @end deffn
9406
9407 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9408 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9409 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9410 @end deffn
9411
9412 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9413 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9414 @end deffn
9415
9416 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9417 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9418 @end deffn
9419
9420 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9421 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9422 @end deffn
9423
9424 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9425 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9426 @end deffn
9427
9428 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9429 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9430 @end deffn
9431
9432 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9433 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9434 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9435 and modifying how it is emptied.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9439 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9440 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9441 The image @var{type} may be one of
9442 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9443 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9444 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9448 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9449 @cindex vector_catch
9450 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9451 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9452
9453 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9454 @example
9455 0x01 Trap Reset
9456 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9457 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9458 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9459 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9460 0x20 reserved
9461 0x40 Trap IRQ
9462 0x80 Trap FIQ
9463 @end example
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9467 @cindex vector_table
9468
9469 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9470 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9471 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9472 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9473 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9474
9475 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9476
9477 @end deffn
9478
9479 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9480 @cindex ARMv6
9481
9482 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9483 @cindex ARM11
9484
9485 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9486 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9487 which is enabled by default.
9488 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9489 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9490 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9491 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9492 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9493 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9494 @end deffn
9495
9496 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9497 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9498 which is enabled by default.
9499 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9500 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9501 @end deffn
9502
9503 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9504 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9505 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9506 they are disabled by default.
9507 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9511 @cindex vector_catch
9512 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9513 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9514 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9515
9516 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9517 for certain hardware events.
9518 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9519 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9520 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9521 @end deffn
9522
9523 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9524 @cindex ARMv7
9525 @cindex ARMv8
9526
9527 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9528 @cindex Cortex-A
9529
9530 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9531 display information about target caches
9532 @end deffn
9533
9534 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9535 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9536 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9537 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9538 Defaults to 'off'.
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9542 Initialize core debug
9543 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9544 @end deffn
9545
9546 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9547 Display/set the current SMP mode
9548 @end deffn
9549
9550 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9551 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9552 @end deffn
9553
9554 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9555 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9556 @end deffn
9557
9558 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9559 configure l2x cache
9560 @end deffn
9561
9562 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9563 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9564 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9565 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9566 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9567 @end deffn
9568
9569 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9570 @cindex Cortex-R
9571
9572 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9573 Initialize core debug
9574 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9575 @end deffn
9576
9577 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9578 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9579 @end deffn
9580
9581
9582 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9583 @cindex tracing
9584 @cindex SWO
9585 @cindex SWV
9586 @cindex TPIU
9587
9588 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9589 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9590 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9591 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9592
9593 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9594 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9595 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9596 which causes quite some confusion.
9597 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9598 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9599
9600 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9601 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9602 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9603
9604 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9605 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9606 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9607 @end deffn
9608
9609 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9610 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9611 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9612 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9613
9614 @itemize @bullet
9615 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9616 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9617 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9618 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9619
9620 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9621 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9622 @end itemize
9623 @end deffn
9624
9625 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9626 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9627 @end deffn
9628
9629 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9630 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9631 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9632 at any time after the initialization, too.
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9636 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9637 individually queried, to return its current value.
9638 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9639 @end deffn
9640
9641 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9642 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9643 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9644 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9645
9646 @itemize @bullet
9647 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9648 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9649
9650 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9651 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9652
9653 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9654 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9655
9656 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9657 protocol used for trace data:
9658 @itemize @minus
9659 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9660 data bits (default);
9661 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9662 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9663 @end itemize
9664
9665 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9666 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9667 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9668 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9669 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9670 of the TPIU.
9671
9672 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9673 the destination of the trace data:
9674 @itemize @minus
9675 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9676 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9677 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9678 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9679 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9680 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9681 each connected client;
9682 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9683 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9684 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9685 @end itemize
9686
9687 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9688 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9689 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9690 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9691
9692 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9693 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9694 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9695 maximum supported rate automatically.
9696
9697 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9698 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9699 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9700
9701 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9702 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9703 default value is @var{0}.
9704 @end itemize
9705 @end deffn
9706
9707 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9708 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9709 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9710 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9711 data.
9712 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9713 after the @command{init}.
9714 @end deffn
9715
9716 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9717 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9718 @end deffn
9719
9720
9721
9722 Example usage:
9723 @enumerate
9724 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9725 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9726 enough to:
9727 @example
9728 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9729 ...
9730 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9731 ...
9732 @end example
9733 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9734 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9735 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9736 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9737 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9738 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9739 @example
9740 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9741 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9742 @end example
9743 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9744 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9745 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9746 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9747 @example
9748 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9749 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9750 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9751 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9752 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9753 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9754 @end example
9755 @end enumerate
9756
9757 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9758 @cindex tracing
9759 @cindex SWO
9760 @cindex SWV
9761 @cindex ITM
9762 @cindex ETM
9763
9764 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9765 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9766 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9767 @end deffn
9768
9769 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9770 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9771 @end deffn
9772
9773 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9774 @cindex Cortex-M
9775
9776 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9777 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9778
9779 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9780 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9781 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9782 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9783 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9784 the step command leaves with the core running.
9785
9786 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9787 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9788 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9789 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9790
9791 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9792 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9793 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9794 does.
9795
9796 Default is @option{auto}.
9797 @end deffn
9798
9799 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9800 @cindex vector_catch
9801 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9802 for certain hardware events.
9803
9804 Parameters request interception of
9805 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9806 @option{none} of them,
9807 or one or more of the following:
9808 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9809 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9810 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9811 @option{irq_err},
9812 @option{state_err},
9813 @option{chk_err}, or
9814 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9815 @option{reset}.
9816 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9817 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9818 are mapped to HardFault.
9819 UsageFault checks for
9820 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9821 must also be explicitly enabled.
9822
9823 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9827 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9828 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9829
9830 @itemize @minus
9831 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9832 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9833 @end itemize
9834
9835 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9836 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9837 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9838 to manually reset the peripherals.
9839 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9840
9841 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9842 instead.
9843 @end deffn
9844
9845 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9846 @cindex ARMv8-A
9847 @cindex aarch64
9848
9849 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9850 Display information about target caches
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9854 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9855 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9856 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9857 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9858 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9862 @cindex disassemble
9863 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9864 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9865 @end deffn
9866
9867 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9868 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9869 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9870 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9871 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9872 @end deffn
9873
9874 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9875 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9876 @option{on}.
9877 @end deffn
9878
9879 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9880 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9881 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9882 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9883 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9884 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9885 @end deffn
9886
9887 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9888
9889 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9890 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9891
9892 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9893
9894 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9895 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9896 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9897 @end deffn
9898
9899 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9900 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9901 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9902 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9903 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9904 @end deffn
9905
9906 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9907
9908 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9909 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9910 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9911 @end deffn
9912
9913 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9914
9915 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9916 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9917 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9918 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9919 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9920 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9921 can be collected.
9922
9923 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9924 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9925 tooling.
9926
9927 @quotation Issues
9928 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9929 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9930 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9931 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9932
9933 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9934 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9935 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9936 software operation on the CPU.
9937 @end quotation
9938
9939 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9940 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9941 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9942 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9943 @end deffn
9944
9945 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9946 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9947 @end deffn
9948
9949 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9950 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9951 control is disabled.
9952 @end deffn
9953
9954 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9955 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9956 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9957 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9958
9959 Supported trace formats:
9960 @itemize
9961 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9962 timing to be determined.
9963 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9964 addresses.
9965 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9966 @end itemize
9967 @end deffn
9968
9969 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9970 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9971 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9972 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9973
9974 Supported conditions:
9975 @itemize
9976 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9977 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9978 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9979 instruction matches start data and mask.
9980 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9981 instruction matches start data and mask.
9982 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9983 data and mask.
9984 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9985 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9986 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9987 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9988 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9989 @end itemize
9990 @end deffn
9991
9992 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9993 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9994 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9995 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9996
9997 Supported conditions:
9998 @itemize
9999 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10000 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10001 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10002 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10003 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10004 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10005 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10006 data and mask.
10007 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10008 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10009 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10010 @end itemize
10011 @end deffn
10012
10013 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10014 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10015
10016 Supported triggers:
10017 @itemize
10018 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10019 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10020 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10021 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10022 collection.
10023 @end itemize
10024 @end deffn
10025
10026 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10027
10028 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10029 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10030 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10031 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10032 @end deffn
10033
10034 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10035 Display trace configuration.
10036 @end deffn
10037
10038 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10039 Display trace collection status.
10040 @end deffn
10041
10042 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10043 Start manual trace collection.
10044 @end deffn
10045
10046 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10047 Stop manual trace collection.
10048 @end deffn
10049
10050 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10051 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10052 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10053 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10054 @option{size} options using DMA.
10055 @end deffn
10056
10057 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10058 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10059 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10060 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10061 @option{size} options using DMA.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @section Intel Architecture
10065
10066 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10067 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10068 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10069 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10070 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10071 @itemize
10072 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10073 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10074 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10075 @end itemize
10076
10077 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10078 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10079 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10080
10081 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10082 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10083 @end deffn
10084
10085 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10086 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10087 @end deffn
10088
10089 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10090 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10091 @end deffn
10092
10093 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10094 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10095 @end deffn
10096
10097 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10098 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10099 @end deffn
10100
10101 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10102 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10103 @end deffn
10104
10105 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10106
10107 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10108 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10109
10110 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10111 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10112 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10113 @end deffn
10114 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10115 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10116
10117 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10118
10119 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10120 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10121 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10122 @end deffn
10123
10124 @subsection Registers commands
10125 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10126 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10127 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10128
10129 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10130
10131 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10132 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10133 and "timer" groups.
10134
10135 @emph{example:}
10136 @example
10137 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10138 @end example
10139
10140 @end deffn
10141
10142 @section RISC-V Architecture
10143
10144 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10145 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10146 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10147 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10148 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10149 implement version 0.11.
10150
10151 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10152
10153 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10154 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10155 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10156
10157 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10158
10159 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10160 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10161 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10162
10163 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10164 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10165 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10166 CSRs.
10167 @end deffn
10168
10169 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10170 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10171 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10172 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10173 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10174 This command must be executed before `init`.
10175 @end deffn
10176
10177 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10178 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10179 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10180 @end deffn
10181
10182 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10183 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10184 deasserted.
10185 @end deffn
10186
10187 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10188 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10189 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10190 @end deffn
10191
10192 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10193 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10194 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10195 on physical memory.
10196 @end deffn
10197
10198 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10199 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10200 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10201 performed on physical memory.
10202 @end deffn
10203
10204 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10205 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10206 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10207 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10208 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10209 race condition problem in your code.
10210
10211 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10212 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10213 @end deffn
10214
10215 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10216 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10217 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10218 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10219 values.
10220
10221 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10222 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10223 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10224 @end deffn
10225
10226 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10227 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10228 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10229 @end deffn
10230
10231 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10232 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10233 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10234 @end deffn
10235
10236 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10237 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10238 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10239 @end deffn
10240
10241 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10242 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10243 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10247
10248 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10249 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10250 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10251 @example
10252 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10253 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10254 @end example
10255
10256 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10257 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10258 @end deffn
10259
10260 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10261 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10262 @end deffn
10263
10264 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10265
10266 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10267 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10268
10269 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10270 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10271 @end deffn
10272
10273 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10274 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10275 @end deffn
10276
10277 @section ARC Architecture
10278 @cindex ARC
10279
10280 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10281 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10282 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10283 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10284 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10285 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10286 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10287 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10288 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10289 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10290 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10291 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10292 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10293 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10294 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10295
10296
10297 @subsection General ARC commands
10298
10299 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10300
10301 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10302 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10303 arguments:
10304
10305 @itemize @bullet
10306
10307 @item @code{-name} name
10308 @*Name of a register.
10309
10310 @item @code{-num} number
10311 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10312
10313 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10314 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10315
10316 @end itemize
10317
10318 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10319
10320 @itemize @bullet
10321
10322 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10323 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10324 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10325 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10326 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10327 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10328
10329 @item @code{-core}
10330 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10331 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10332 spaces.
10333
10334 @item @code{-bcr}
10335 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10336 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10337 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10338 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10339 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10340
10341 @item @code{-type} type_name
10342 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10343 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10344
10345 @item @code{-g}
10346 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10347 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10348 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10349 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10350 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10351
10352 @end itemize
10353
10354 @end deffn
10355
10356 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10357 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10358 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10359 @end deffn
10360
10361 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10362 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10363 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10364 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10365 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10366 startbit endbit}.
10367 @end deffn
10368
10369 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10370 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10371 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10372 @end deffn
10373
10374 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10375 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10376 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10377 @end deffn
10378
10379 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10380
10381 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10382 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10383 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10384 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10385
10386 @end deffn
10387
10388 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10389 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10390 registers.
10391 @end deffn
10392
10393 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10394 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10395 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10396 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10397
10398 @end deffn
10399
10400 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10401 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10402 registers.
10403 @end deffn
10404
10405 @section STM8 Architecture
10406 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10407 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10408
10409 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10410 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10411
10412 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10413 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10414 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10415 @cindex tracing
10416 @cindex libdcc
10417 @cindex DCC
10418 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10419 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10420 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10421 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10422
10423 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10424 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10425 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10426 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10427 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10428 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10429
10430 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10431 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10432 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10433 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10434 The target being debugged may
10435 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10436 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10437 each supported by a command:
10438
10439 @itemize
10440 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10441 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10442 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10443 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10444
10445 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10446 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10447 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10448
10449 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10450 and then displayed at any time.
10451 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10452
10453 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10454 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10455 @end itemize
10456
10457 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10458 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10459 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10460 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10461 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10462 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10463 does the same thing.
10464
10465 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10466 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10467 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10468 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10469 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10470
10471 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10472 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10473 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10474 @end deffn
10475
10476 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10477 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10478 in the order they triggered.
10479 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10480 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10481 history records.
10482 @end deffn
10483
10484 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10485 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10486 they have been triggered.
10487 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10488 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10489 and associates it with that identifier.
10490
10491 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10492 are not related except by this command.
10493 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10494 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10495 @end deffn
10496
10497
10498 @node JTAG Commands
10499 @chapter JTAG Commands
10500 @cindex JTAG Commands
10501 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10502 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10503 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10504 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10505 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10506
10507 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10508 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10509
10510 @itemize @bullet
10511 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10512 devices such as a CPUs.
10513 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10514 standard state machine (in parallel)
10515 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10516 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10517 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10518 while the reading previous ones.
10519 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10520 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10521 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10522 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10523 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10524 registers.
10525 @end itemize
10526
10527 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10528
10529 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10530 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10531 the order of TAP state transitions.
10532 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10533 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10534 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10535 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10536 these commands are not available.
10537
10538 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10539 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10540 that specify the entire register.
10541 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10542 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10543 The return value holds the original value of each
10544 of those fields.
10545
10546 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10547 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10548 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10549 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10550 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10551
10552 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10553 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10554
10555 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10556 in that state.
10557 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10558 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10559 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10560
10561 @quotation Warning
10562 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10563 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10564 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10565 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10566 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10567 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10568 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10569 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10570 @end quotation
10571 @end deffn
10572
10573 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10574 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10575 This may be used for performance tuning.
10576
10577 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10578 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10579 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10580 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10581 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10582 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10583 @end deffn
10584
10585 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10586 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10587 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10588 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10589 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10590 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10591
10592 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10593 in that state.
10594 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10595 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10596 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10597
10598 @quotation Note
10599 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10600 register values, unlike data register values.
10601 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10602 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10603 @end quotation
10604 @end deffn
10605
10606 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10607 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10608 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10609 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10610 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10611 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10612 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10613 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10614 The final state must also be stable.
10615 @end deffn
10616
10617 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10618 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10619 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10620 Instructions often need some time
10621 to execute before they take effect.
10622 @end deffn
10623
10624 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10625 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10626
10627 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10628 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10629 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10630 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10631 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10632 @end deffn
10633
10634 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10635 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10636 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10637 must also be enabled.
10638 Default is enabled.
10639 @end deffn
10640
10641 @section TAP state names
10642 @cindex TAP state names
10643
10644 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10645 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10646 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10647 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10648
10649 @itemize @bullet
10650 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10651 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10652 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10653 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10654 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10655 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10656 through the data register
10657 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10658 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10659 for update or more shifting
10660 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10661 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10662 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10663 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10664 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10665 through the instruction register
10666 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10667 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10668 for update or more shifting
10669 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10670 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10671 @end itemize
10672
10673 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10674 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10675 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10676 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10677
10678 @itemize @bullet
10679 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10680 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10681 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10682 may not be as expected.
10683 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10684 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10685 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10686 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10687 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10688 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10689 @end itemize
10690
10691 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10692 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10693
10694 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10695 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10696 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10697 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10698
10699 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10700 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10701 @cindex SVF
10702
10703 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10704 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10705 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10706 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10707
10708 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10709 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10710 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10711 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10712
10713 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10714 affect their semantics.
10715
10716 Command options:
10717 @itemize @minus
10718 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10719 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10720 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10721 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10722 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10723 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10724 on the real interface;
10725 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10726 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10727 errors.
10728 @end itemize
10729 @end deffn
10730
10731 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10732 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10733 @cindex XSVF
10734
10735 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10736 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10737 Xilinx devices.
10738 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10739 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10740
10741 @quotation Important
10742 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10743 @end quotation
10744
10745 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10746 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10747 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10748 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10749 that TAP.
10750 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10751 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10752 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10753 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10754 @end deffn
10755
10756 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10757 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10758 after building the software.
10759 You may find them useful:
10760
10761 @itemize
10762 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10763 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10764 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10765 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10766 @end itemize
10767
10768 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10769 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10770 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10771 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10772 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10773 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10774 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10775
10776
10777 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10778 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10779 @cindex IPDBG
10780
10781 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10782 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10783 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10784 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10785 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10786 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10787
10788 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10789 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10790
10791 Command options:
10792 @itemize @bullet
10793 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10794 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10795 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10796 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10797 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10798 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10799 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10800 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10801 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10802 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10803 shift data through vir can be configured.
10804 @end itemize
10805 @end deffn
10806
10807 Examples:
10808 @example
10809 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10810 @end example
10811 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10812 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10813
10814 @example
10815 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10816 @end example
10817 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10818 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10819
10820 @node Utility Commands
10821 @chapter Utility Commands
10822 @cindex Utility Commands
10823
10824 @section RAM testing
10825 @cindex RAM testing
10826
10827 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10828 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10829 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10830 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10831 hardware problems.
10832
10833 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10834 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10835 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10836 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10837
10838 Load the memory testing functions with
10839
10840 @example
10841 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10842 @end example
10843
10844 to get access to the following facilities:
10845
10846 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10847 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10848 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10849 @end deffn
10850
10851 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10852 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10853 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10854 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10855 @end deffn
10856
10857 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10858 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10859 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10860 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10861 @end deffn
10862
10863 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10864 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10865 @end deffn
10866
10867 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10868 @cindex Firmware recovery
10869
10870 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10871 devices recovery with JTAG.
10872
10873 For quickstart instructions run:
10874 @example
10875 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10876 @end example
10877
10878 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10879 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10880 @cindex GDB
10881 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10882 to debug remote targets.
10883 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10884
10885 @itemize
10886 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10887 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10888 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10889 as shown in this chapter.
10890 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10891 that also will probably need to be configured.
10892 @end itemize
10893
10894 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10895 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10896 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10897 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10898 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10899 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10900
10901 @section Connecting to GDB
10902 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10903 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10904 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10905 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10906 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10907
10908 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10909
10910 @enumerate
10911 @item
10912 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10913 @example
10914 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10915 @end example
10916 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10917
10918 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10919 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10920 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10921
10922 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10923 remote command above that becomes:
10924 @example
10925 tar ext :3333
10926 @end example
10927
10928 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10929 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10930 available through the command:
10931 @example
10932 target remote localhost:3333
10933 @end example
10934
10935 @item
10936 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10937 @example
10938 target extended-remote | \
10939 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10940 @end example
10941 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10942 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10943 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10944 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10945 @end enumerate
10946
10947 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10948 GDB command line.
10949
10950 @section Sample GDB session startup
10951
10952 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10953 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10954 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10955 small ARM program.
10956 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10957 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10958
10959 @example
10960 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10961 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10962 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10963 ...
10964 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10965 ...
10966 (gdb) load
10967 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10968 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10969 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10970 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10971 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10972 (gdb) continue
10973 Continuing.
10974 ...
10975 @end example
10976
10977 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10978 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10979 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10980 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10981
10982 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10983
10984 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10985 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10986 packet size and the device's memory map.
10987 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10988 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10989 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10990
10991 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10992 You may need to set those up by hand.
10993 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10994 something like:
10995
10996 @example
10997 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10998 @end example
10999
11000 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11001
11002 @example
11003 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11004 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11005 @end example
11006
11007 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11008 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11009 do not have such restrictions.
11010
11011 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11012 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11013 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11014 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11015
11016 @section Programming using GDB
11017 @cindex Programming using GDB
11018 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11019
11020 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11021 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11022 @example
11023 gdb_memory_map disable
11024 @end example
11025 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11026 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11027 working area.
11028
11029 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11030 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11031 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11032 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11033
11034 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11035 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11036
11037 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11038 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11039 @example
11040 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11041 @end example
11042
11043 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11044 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11045
11046 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11047 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11048 will be used.
11049
11050 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11051 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11052 @example
11053 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11054 @end example
11055 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11056
11057 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11058 can be used.
11059
11060 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11061 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11062 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11063
11064 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11065 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11066 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11067
11068 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11069 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11070 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11071 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11072 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11073 without any intrusion of the target process.
11074
11075 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11076 Place following command after target configuration:
11077 @example
11078 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11079 @end example
11080
11081 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11082 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11083 @example
11084 gdb_memory_map disable
11085 @end example
11086
11087 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11088 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11089 @example
11090 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11091 @end example
11092
11093 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11094 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11095
11096 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11097 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11098 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11099 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11100
11101 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11102 previously shown variables.
11103
11104 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11105 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11106 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11107 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11108 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11109
11110 @section RTOS Support
11111 @cindex RTOS Support
11112 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11113
11114 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11115 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11116
11117 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11118 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11119 GDB commands.
11120
11121 @* An example setup is below:
11122
11123 @example
11124 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11125 @end example
11126
11127 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11128
11129 Currently supported rtos's include:
11130 @itemize @bullet
11131 @item @option{eCos}
11132 @item @option{ThreadX}
11133 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11134 @item @option{linux}
11135 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11136 @item @option{embKernel}
11137 @item @option{mqx}
11138 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11139 @item @option{nuttx}
11140 @item @option{RIOT}
11141 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11142 @item @option{Zephyr}
11143 @end itemize
11144
11145 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11146 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11147
11148 @table @code
11149 @item eCos symbols
11150 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11151 @item ThreadX symbols
11152 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11153 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11154 @raggedright
11155 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11156 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11157 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11158 @end raggedright
11159 @item linux symbols
11160 init_task.
11161 @item ChibiOS symbols
11162 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11163 @item embKernel symbols
11164 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11165 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11166 @item mqx symbols
11167 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11168 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11169 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11170 @item nuttx symbols
11171 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11172 @item RIOT symbols
11173 @raggedright
11174 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11175 _tcb_name_offset.
11176 @end raggedright
11177 @item Zephyr symbols
11178 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11179 @end table
11180
11181 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11182 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11183
11184 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11185 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11186
11187 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11188 along with the project:
11189
11190 @table @code
11191 @item FreeRTOS
11192 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11193 @item uC/OS-III
11194 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11195 @end table
11196
11197 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11198 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11199 @cindex SMP
11200 @cindex RTOS
11201 @cindex hwthread
11202 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11203 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11204 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11205 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11206 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11207 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11208 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11209 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11210 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11211
11212 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11213 @quotation Note
11214 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11215 @end quotation
11216
11217 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11218 @itemize @bullet
11219 @item j - smp status request
11220 @item J - smp set request
11221 @end itemize
11222
11223 OpenOCD implements :
11224 @itemize @bullet
11225 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11226 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11227 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11228 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11229 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11230 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11231 @end itemize
11232
11233 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11234 @itemize @bullet
11235 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11236 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11237 @example
11238 set $_core 1
11239 #Jc01 packet is sent
11240 print $_core
11241 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11242 @end example
11243
11244 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11245 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11246
11247 @example
11248 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11249 define toggle0
11250 maint packet Jc0
11251 continue
11252 main packet Jc-1
11253 end
11254 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11255 define toggle1
11256 maint packet Jc1
11257 continue
11258 main packet Jc-1
11259 end
11260 @end example
11261 @end itemize
11262
11263 @node Tcl Scripting API
11264 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11265 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11266 @cindex Tcl scripts
11267 @section API rules
11268
11269 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11270 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11271 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11272
11273 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11274 pair list and lists.
11275
11276 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11277 list.
11278
11279 @example
11280 > set foo(me) Duane
11281 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11282 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11283 > set foo(duck) Donald
11284 @end example
11285
11286 If one does this:
11287
11288 @example
11289 > set foo
11290 @end example
11291
11292 The result is:
11293
11294 @example
11295 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11296 @end example
11297
11298 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11299
11300 @verbatim
11301 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11302 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11303 }
11304 @end verbatim
11305
11306 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11307 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11308
11309 @section Internal low-level Commands
11310
11311 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11312 invoke directly.
11313
11314 @itemize @bullet
11315 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11316
11317 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11318 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11319
11320 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11321 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11322
11323 Return information about the flash banks
11324
11325 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11326
11327 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11328 its execution. Example:
11329
11330 @example
11331 > capture "reset init"
11332 @end example
11333
11334 @end itemize
11335
11336 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11337 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11338 called "flash_banks".
11339
11340 @section Tcl RPC server
11341 @cindex RPC
11342
11343 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11344 commands and receive the results.
11345
11346 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11347 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11348 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11349 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11350 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11351
11352 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11353 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11354 @command{capture} command.
11355
11356 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11357
11358 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11359 @cindex RPC Notifications
11360
11361 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11362 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11363
11364 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11365 in the following format.
11366
11367 @verbatim
11368 type target_event event [event-name]
11369 type target_state state [state-name]
11370 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11371 @end verbatim
11372
11373 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11374 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11375 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11376 Defaults to off.
11377
11378 @end deffn
11379
11380 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11381 @cindex RPC trace output
11382
11383 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11384 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11385
11386 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11387
11388 @verbatim
11389 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11390 @end verbatim
11391
11392 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11393 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11394 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11395 Defaults to off.
11396
11397 See an example application here:
11398 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11399
11400 @end deffn
11401
11402 @node FAQ
11403 @chapter FAQ
11404 @cindex faq
11405 @enumerate
11406 @anchor{faqrtck}
11407 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11408 @cindex RTCK
11409 @cindex adaptive clocking
11410 @*
11411
11412 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11413 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11414 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11415 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11416
11417 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11418 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11419 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11420 @enumerate
11421 @item
11422 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11423 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11424 @item
11425 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11426 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11427 @end enumerate
11428
11429 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11430 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11431 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11432 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11433 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11434 power).
11435
11436 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11437 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11438 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11439 ARM926 scenario).
11440 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11441 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11442 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11443
11444 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11445 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11446 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11447 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11448
11449 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11450
11451 In order to make use of this,
11452 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11453 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11454
11455 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11456 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11457 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11458 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11459 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11460
11461 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11462 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11463 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11464 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11465
11466 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11467 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11468 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11469 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11470 with a CPLD.
11471 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11472 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11473 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11474 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11475 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11476 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11477
11478 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11479
11480 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11481
11482 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11483 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11484 depending on the chips on your board.
11485 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11486 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11487 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11488
11489 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11490 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11491 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11492
11493 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11494 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11495 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11496 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11497
11498 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11499 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11500 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11501 this way.
11502
11503 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11504 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11505 clock rate.
11506 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11507 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11508 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11509
11510 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11511
11512 @example
11513 # Example: 1.234MHz
11514 adapter speed 1234
11515 @end example
11516
11517
11518 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11519
11520 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11521 around Windows filenames.
11522
11523 @example
11524 > echo \a
11525
11526 > echo @{\a@}
11527 \a
11528 > echo "\a"
11529
11530 >
11531 @end example
11532
11533
11534 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11535
11536 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11537 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11538 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11539
11540 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11541 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11542 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11543
11544 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11545 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11546 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11547
11548 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11549
11550 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11551 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11552 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11553 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11554
11555 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11556 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11557 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11558
11559 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11560 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11561
11562 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11563 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11564 memory read caused data abort".
11565
11566 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11567 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11568 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11569 be done, feel free to add this here.
11570
11571 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11572 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11573 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11574 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11575 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11576 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11577 gracefully stops.
11578
11579 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11580 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11581 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11582
11583 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11584 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11585 bytes. Painful...
11586
11587
11588 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11589 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11590
11591 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11592 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11593 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11594 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11595 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11596 reset, everything else should work fine.
11597
11598 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11599 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11600 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11601 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11602
11603 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11604 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11605 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11606 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11607
11608 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11609
11610 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11611 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11612 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11613
11614 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11615 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11616
11617 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11618 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11619 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11620 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11621 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11622 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11623 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11624 clock frequency?
11625
11626 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11627 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11628 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11629 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11630 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11631
11632 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11633
11634 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11635 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11636 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11637 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11638 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11639 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11640 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11641
11642 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11643
11644 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11645 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11646 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11647 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11648
11649 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11650 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11651 particular order?
11652
11653 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11654 the same order used by the hardware.
11655
11656 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11657 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11658 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11659 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11660 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11661 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11662
11663 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11664 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11665 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11666 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11667
11668 @itemize @bullet
11669 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11670 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11671 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11672 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11673 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11674 @end itemize
11675
11676 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11677
11678 @itemize @bullet
11679 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11680 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11681 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11682 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11683 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11684 @end itemize
11685
11686
11687 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11688 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11689 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11690
11691 TODO.
11692
11693 @end enumerate
11694
11695 @node Tcl Crash Course
11696 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11697 @cindex Tcl
11698
11699 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11700 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11701 how the Tcl scripts work.
11702
11703 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11704 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11705 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11706 OpenOCD.
11707
11708 @section Tcl Rule #1
11709 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11710 @enumerate
11711 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11712 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11713 @end enumerate
11714
11715 The Tcl equal is this:
11716
11717 @enumerate
11718 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11719 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11720 @end enumerate
11721
11722 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11723 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11724
11725 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11726 There is a second pair of rules.
11727 @enumerate
11728 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11729 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11730 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11731 in Tcl.
11732 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11733 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11734 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11735 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11736 @end enumerate
11737
11738 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11739 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11740 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11741 Everything is a string}
11742
11743 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11744 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11745 difference is subtle.
11746 @enumerate
11747 @item Parse Time
11748 @item Evaluation Time
11749 @end enumerate
11750
11751 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11752 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11753 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11754
11755 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11756 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11757 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11758 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11759
11760 @itemize @bullet
11761 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11762 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11763 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11764 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11765 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11766 @example
11767 # bash example
11768 X=`date`
11769 echo "The Date is: $X"
11770 # Tcl example
11771 set X [date]
11772 puts "The Date is: $X"
11773 @end example
11774 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11775 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11776 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11777 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11778 is a string}
11779 @example
11780 set x "Dinner"
11781 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11782 @end example
11783 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11784 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11785 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11786 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11787 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11788 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11789 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11790 @end itemize
11791
11792 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11793
11794 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11795
11796 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11797
11798 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11799 the normal way.
11800
11801 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11802 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11803 line is immediately executed.
11804
11805 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11806 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11807
11808 @subsection Command Execution
11809
11810 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11811 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11812 control flow operators.
11813
11814 Commands are executed like this:
11815
11816 @enumerate
11817 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11818 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11819 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11820 @end enumerate
11821
11822 It sort of works like this:
11823 @example
11824 for(;;)@{
11825 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11826
11827 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11828
11829 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11830 @}
11831 @end example
11832
11833 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11834 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11835 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11836 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11837 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11838 ``LookupCommand()''
11839
11840 @subsection The FOR command
11841
11842 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11843 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11844 command just like any other command.
11845
11846 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11847 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11848 are:
11849
11850 @enumerate 0
11851 @item The ascii text 'for'
11852 @item The start text
11853 @item The test expression
11854 @item The next text
11855 @item The body text
11856 @end enumerate
11857
11858 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11859 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11860 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11861 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11862
11863 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11864 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11865
11866 @example
11867 int
11868 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11869 int *argc,
11870 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11871 @end example
11872
11873 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11874 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11875 still operates in the same basic way.
11876
11877 @subsection FOR command implementation
11878
11879 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11880 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11881
11882 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11883
11884 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11885
11886 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11887 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11888 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11889
11890 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11891 expression and returns a value.
11892
11893 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11894 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11895 @example
11896 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11897
11898 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11899
11900 int
11901 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11902 int argc,
11903 char **argv )
11904 @{
11905 if( argc != 5 )@{
11906 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11907 return ERROR;
11908 @}
11909
11910 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11911
11912 // Execute the start statement.
11913 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11914
11915 // Top of loop test
11916 for(;;)@{
11917 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11918 if( i == 0 )
11919 break;
11920
11921 // Execute the body
11922 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11923
11924 // Execute the LOOP part
11925 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11926 @}
11927
11928 // Return no error
11929 SetResult( interp, "" );
11930 return SUCCESS;
11931 @}
11932 @end example
11933
11934 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11935 in the same basic way.
11936
11937 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11938
11939 @subsection source and find commands
11940 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11941 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11942 @*Remember the parsing rules
11943 @enumerate
11944 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11945 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11946 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11947 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11948 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11949 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11950 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11951 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11952 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11953 @end enumerate
11954 @subsection format command
11955 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11956 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11957 @b{sprintf()}.
11958 @b{Example}
11959 @example
11960 set x 6
11961 set y 7
11962 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11963 @end example
11964 @enumerate
11965 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11966 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11967 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11968 @* Refer to Rule #1
11969 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11970 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11971 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11972 @end enumerate
11973 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11974 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11975 @example
11976 #1 Good
11977 proc someproc @{@} @{
11978 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11979 @}
11980 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11981 #2 Good - no variables
11982 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11983 #3 Good Curly Braces
11984 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11985 puts "Time: [date]"
11986 @}
11987 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11988 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11989 @end example
11990 @enumerate
11991 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11992 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11993 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11994 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11995 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11996 command.
11997 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11998 @*There are 4 examples:
11999 @enumerate
12000 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12001 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12002 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12003 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12004 @end enumerate
12005
12006 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12007 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12008 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12009
12010 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12011 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12012 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12013 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12014 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12015 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12016 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12017 @end enumerate
12018 @subsection Global Variables
12019 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12020 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12021 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12022 @example
12023 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12024 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12025 global x #Global variable X
12026 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12027 @}
12028 @end example
12029 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12030 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12031 @example
12032 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12033 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12034 # Create var name
12035 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12036 # Make it a global
12037 global $vn
12038 # Set it.
12039 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12040 @}
12041 @end example
12042 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12043 @example
12044 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12045 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12046 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12047 @}
12048 @end example
12049
12050 @node License
12051 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12052 @include fdl.texi
12053
12054 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12055 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12056 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12057 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12058 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12059 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12060
12061 @printindex cp
12062
12063 @node Command and Driver Index
12064 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12065 @printindex fn
12066
12067 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)